Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S manuel d'utilisation
- Voir en ligne ou télécharger le manuel d’utilisation
- 964 pages
- 16.5 mb
Aller à la page of
Les manuels d’utilisation similaires
-
Garage Door Opener
Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S
964 pages 16.5 mb -
Garage Door Opener
Mitsubishi Electronics FX3U
964 pages 16.5 mb -
Garage Door Opener
Mitsubishi Electronics FX3GC
964 pages 16.5 mb -
Garage Door Opener
Mitsubishi Electronics FX3UC
964 pages 16.5 mb -
Garage Door Opener
Mitsubishi Electronics fx3u
284 pages 6.45 mb
Un bon manuel d’utilisation
Les règles imposent au revendeur l'obligation de fournir à l'acheteur, avec des marchandises, le manuel d’utilisation Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S. Le manque du manuel d’utilisation ou les informations incorrectes fournies au consommateur sont à la base d'une plainte pour non-conformité du dispositif avec le contrat. Conformément à la loi, l’inclusion du manuel d’utilisation sous une forme autre que le papier est autorisée, ce qui est souvent utilisé récemment, en incluant la forme graphique ou électronique du manuel Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S ou les vidéos d'instruction pour les utilisateurs. La condition est son caractère lisible et compréhensible.
Qu'est ce que le manuel d’utilisation?
Le mot vient du latin "Instructio", à savoir organiser. Ainsi, le manuel d’utilisation Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S décrit les étapes de la procédure. Le but du manuel d’utilisation est d’instruire, de faciliter le démarrage, l'utilisation de l'équipement ou l'exécution des actions spécifiques. Le manuel d’utilisation est une collection d'informations sur l'objet/service, une indice.
Malheureusement, peu d'utilisateurs prennent le temps de lire le manuel d’utilisation, et un bon manuel permet non seulement d’apprendre à connaître un certain nombre de fonctionnalités supplémentaires du dispositif acheté, mais aussi éviter la majorité des défaillances.
Donc, ce qui devrait contenir le manuel parfait?
Tout d'abord, le manuel d’utilisation Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S devrait contenir:
- informations sur les caractéristiques techniques du dispositif Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S
- nom du fabricant et année de fabrication Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S
- instructions d'utilisation, de réglage et d’entretien de l'équipement Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S
- signes de sécurité et attestations confirmant la conformité avec les normes pertinentes
Pourquoi nous ne lisons pas les manuels d’utilisation?
Habituellement, cela est dû au manque de temps et de certitude quant à la fonctionnalité spécifique de l'équipement acheté. Malheureusement, la connexion et le démarrage Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S ne suffisent pas. Le manuel d’utilisation contient un certain nombre de lignes directrices concernant les fonctionnalités spécifiques, la sécurité, les méthodes d'entretien (même les moyens qui doivent être utilisés), les défauts possibles Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S et les moyens de résoudre des problèmes communs lors de l'utilisation. Enfin, le manuel contient les coordonnées du service Mitsubishi Electronics en l'absence de l'efficacité des solutions proposées. Actuellement, les manuels d’utilisation sous la forme d'animations intéressantes et de vidéos pédagogiques qui sont meilleurs que la brochure, sont très populaires. Ce type de manuel permet à l'utilisateur de voir toute la vidéo d'instruction sans sauter les spécifications et les descriptions techniques compliquées Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S, comme c’est le cas pour la version papier.
Pourquoi lire le manuel d’utilisation?
Tout d'abord, il contient la réponse sur la structure, les possibilités du dispositif Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S, l'utilisation de divers accessoires et une gamme d'informations pour profiter pleinement de toutes les fonctionnalités et commodités.
Après un achat réussi de l’équipement/dispositif, prenez un moment pour vous familiariser avec toutes les parties du manuel d'utilisation Mitsubishi Electronics FX3S. À l'heure actuelle, ils sont soigneusement préparés et traduits pour qu'ils soient non seulement compréhensibles pour les utilisateurs, mais pour qu’ils remplissent leur fonction de base de l'information et d’aide.
Table des matières du manuel d’utilisation
-
Page 1
FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC SERIES PROGR AMMABLE CON TROLLERS PROGRAMMING MANUAL Basic & Applied Instruction Edition[...]
-
Page 2
[...]
-
Page 3
1 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programmable Controllers Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Foreword This manual contains text, diagrams and explanations which will guide the reader through the safe and corr[...]
-
Page 4
2 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Outline Precautions • This manual provides information for the use of the FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programmable Controllers. The manual has been written to be used by trained and competent personnel. The definition of such a[...]
-
Page 5
3 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents Table of Contents Related manuals ....................... ................. ............ ............. ................. ............ ............. ..... ............. 14 Generic Names and Abbreviations Used in Manual s ......[...]
-
Page 6
4 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 4.4 State Relay [S] ....................... .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. 94 4.4.1 Numbers of state relays . ........... .......... ....[...]
-
Page 7
5 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 5. How to Spec ify Devices and C onstants to Instruc tions 153 5.1 Numeric Values Handled in PLC (Octal, Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Numbers) ........................ . 153 5.1.1 Type s of nume ric values ...................[...]
-
Page 8
6 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 8. Program Flow – FNC 00 to FNC 09 220 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump..................... .............. .............. .............. .............. .............. . ..... ......... 221 8.1.1 CJ inst ruction an d ope[...]
-
Page 9
7 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 12. Data Operation – FNC 40 to FNC 49 315 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset .... ...................................................................... ........... .......... ....... ...... 316 12.2 FNC 41 – DECO / Decode [...]
-
Page 10
8 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Special Function Bl ock ............... ........... .............. ........... ............ ... 448 15.9.1 Common items between FROM ins truction and TO instructi on (details) ...............[...]
-
Page 11
9 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 20. Positioning Control – FNC150 to FNC159 547 20.1 FNC150 – DSZR / Dog Search Zero Return ............... .............. .............. ................. .............. ......... ... 548 20.2 FNC151 – DVIT / Int errupt [...]
-
Page 12
10 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 26.8 FNC207 – MIDW / Random Replac ement of Character Strings .............................. ................. ......... 633 26.9 FNC208 – INSTR / Charact er string search...................... .............. ............[...]
-
Page 13
11 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 34. FX 3U -CF-ADP Applied Instructions – FNC300 to FNC3 05 741 34.1 FNC300 – FLCRT / File create • check ................ ........... ........... .............. ........... ............ .............. ...... 742 34.1.1 [...]
-
Page 14
12 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents 37. Operation of Special Devices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 824 37.1 Special Device List (M8000 -, D8000 -) ........ .............. .............. .............. .............. ................. .. .......... 824 37.1.1 Special Aux i[...]
-
Page 15
13 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Table of Contents Appendix B: Instruction Execution Time 917 Appendix B-1 Basic Instruction Execution Time ......... .............. ............................................... .................. 917 Appendix B-2 Step Ladder Instruction Exe[...]
-
Page 16
14 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Related manuals For detailed explanation of prog ramming (bas ic instructions , appl ied instructions an d step ladder instructio ns) in FX 3S / FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs, refer to this manual. For hardwa re informati [...]
-
Page 17
15 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Programming ~ Additiona l Manual FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programmi ng Manual - Basic & A pplied I nstructio n Edition (this manual) JY997D16601 Items related to programming in PLCs including explanat[...]
-
Page 18
16 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Ethernet, CC-Link, MELSEC I/O LINK an d AS-i system When using each product, re fer also to t he User’s Ma nual - Hardwar e Edition of the PLC main unit to which each product is connected. U Supplied with product FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 19
17 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls U Supplied with product FX 3UC -4AD Installation Manual JY 997D14901 Handling procedures of the 4-channel an alog input spec ial func tion block . For use, re fer to the FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series User ’s Man[...]
-
Page 20
18 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Analog I/O (mixed) When using each product, re fer also to t he User’s Ma nual - Hardwar e Edition of the PLC main unit to which each product is connected. U Supplied with product FX 3U -3A-ADP User’s Manual JY997D3560[...]
-
Page 21
19 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Programmable cam switch When using each product, re fer also to t he User’s Ma nual - Hardwar e Edition of the PLC main unit to which each product is connected. Supplied with product FX 2N -1RM-E-SET User’s Manual [...]
-
Page 22
20 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Related manua ls Memory cassette U Supplied with product Memory cassette FX 3G -EEPROM-32L Installation Manual JY997D32401 S pecific ations and ope rating proc edures of the memory cassette. − U Supplied with product FX 3U -FLROM-16/64/6[...]
-
Page 23
21 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Generic Name s and Abbre viations Us ed in Manua ls Generic Names and Abbreviations Used in Manuals Abbreviation/generic name Name Programmable cont rollers FX 3S Series Generic name of FX 3S Series PLCs FX 3S PLC or main unit Generic name of [...]
-
Page 24
22 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Generic Name s and Abbre viations Us ed in Manua ls CC-Link/LT eq uipment Generic name of CC-Link/LT mas ter statio n, CC-Link/L T remote I/O sta tions, CC-Li nk/LT remote device stations, po wer supply adapters, and dedicated po wer supplies [...]
-
Page 25
23 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 1 Introduction 1.1 Programming Language i n PLCs 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move &[...]
-
Page 26
24 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 1 Introduction 1.1 Programming Language i n PLCs 4. ST (structu red text) 1) Features The ST language is a text language with a si milar grammatical structure to the C language. The ST language can describe control achieved by syntax using sel[...]
-
Page 27
25 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.1 Introductio n of Convenient Functions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow[...]
-
Page 28
26 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.1 Introductio n of Convenient Functions 5. Three types of "interrupt " functions for recei ving short-p eriod pulses and priority processing → Refer to Chapter 36. 1) Input interrupt *1 Signals from[...]
-
Page 29
27 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.2 Introducti on of Applied Inst ructions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flo[...]
-
Page 30
28 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.2 Introducti on of Applied Inst ructions 3. Arithmetic and logical operatio ns • Addition (ADD/FNC 20) • Subtraction (SUB/FNC 21) • Multiplic ation (MUL/FNC 22) • Division (DIV/FNC 23) • Increment (IN[...]
-
Page 31
29 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.3 Analog/Positio ning Special Control 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9[...]
-
Page 32
30 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.5 Introduction of Devices Constructing PLC 2.5 Introduction of Devices Constructing PLC Many relays, time rs, and counters are built into an FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs, with many NO (normal ly ope[...]
-
Page 33
31 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.5 Introduction of Devices Constructing PLC 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 34
32 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.5 Introduction of Devices Constructing PLC 8. Index registers ( V)(Z) → Refer to Secti on 4.11. Among registers, th ere are index typ e registers V and Z used for modification. A data regi ster V or Z i s add[...]
-
Page 35
33 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 36
34 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 2. In FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs are equipped w ith the EEPROM memory as stand ard. 1) When usin g the built -in memory (wit hout atta ched memory cassette) 2) When usi[...]
-
Page 37
35 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 38
36 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 2.6.2 Memory operations and latched (batte ry or EEPROM backed) devices (power ON/OFF and RUN/STOP) 1. Backup operation The operations of the data memory, b it device memory and p[...]
-
Page 39
37 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 40
38 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es c) FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs *1. Device values are not bac ked up correctly when the b attery voltage become s lower than the holding vol tage. *2. The contents of the program memory and[...]
-
Page 41
39 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 42
40 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es b) FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs *1. These re gisters c an be change d from the general type to the latc hed (batter y backed) type by the parameter setting when the optiona l battery is ins[...]
-
Page 43
41 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 44
42 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 2.6.3 Types of backup methods against power failure There are the followin g types of latch (batt ery backup) for the prog ram memory and built-in PL C devices. 1. Battery back up[...]
-
Page 45
43 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.6 Program Me mory and Devic es 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-[...]
-
Page 46
44 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters Setting of para meters means settin g the environment whe re the PLC operat es. Almost all FX PLC ca n be used with factory default values. [...]
-
Page 47
45 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 48
46 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2) FX 3G /FX 3G C PLCs *1. In the cas e of FX 3GC PLC, sele ct "FX 3G " as the PLC type. *2. These programmin g tools are not a pplicable to F X 3G /FX 3GC PLCs. The [...]
-
Page 49
47 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 50
48 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2.7.3 Memory capacity setting ra nge Cautions on setting th e memory capacity • After changing the memo ry ca pacity setting, make sur e to write both the programs and parame[...]
-
Page 51
49 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 52
50 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2.7.5 Keyword (entry code) By registering the entry code in a PLC, the functions of pr ogramming tools, d isplay modules, and disp lay units to change programs, monitor devices[...]
-
Page 53
51 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 54
52 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters Registering and changing the entry codes This section expl ains the operating proc edure of GX Works2, GX Devel oper. → For the entry co de registration/chan ge proc edure in[...]
-
Page 55
53 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 56
54 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters • GX Developer Click [Execution ] button to open Ke yword confirmation dia log box. Enter the same keyword ag ain, and click the [OK ] button to regi ster the ke yword to the[...]
-
Page 57
55 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 58
56 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters Canceling the entry codes This section expl ains the operating proc edure of GX Works2, GX Devel oper. → For the entry code can celing (deletio n) procedure in FX- 10P(-E), F[...]
-
Page 59
57 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 60
58 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2.7.6 Special unit initial value setting The initial v alues of th e buffer memo ry (BFM) in spe cial function units/blocks connected to an FX 3UC PLC V er.2.20 or later and FX[...]
-
Page 61
59 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 62
60 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 3 Setting devices 1. Click [Device] t ab, and set devices. 4 Setting the PLC name 1. Click [PLC Name] tab, and in put the program title . Set item Contents of sett ing Setting [...]
-
Page 63
61 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 64
62 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 2. On Special Function Block Settings dialog box, set the initial values of special funct ion units/ blocks. *1. Input buffer memory addresses (BFM nu mbers) that in the connec[...]
-
Page 65
63 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 66
64 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 7 Setting the PLC system (1) Click on the [PL C System(1)] t ab to setup "Batte ry Less Mode", "Bat tery Mode ", "MODEM Initialize d", and "R[...]
-
Page 67
65 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 68
66 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 9 Setting positioning 1. Click [Positioning] tab. In order to use the [Posit ioning] tab, th e "Position ing In struction Settings" box in the [Memory Capacity] tab m[...]
-
Page 69
67 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 70
68 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 3. Click [Individual setting] button to displa y Positioning Instruction Set tings dialog box. In this dialog box, set th e positioning table for each pulse output dest ination[...]
-
Page 71
69 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 2 Overview (Seque nce Program) 2.7 Types and Setting of Parameters 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 72
70 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.1 Basi c Instru ctions 3. Instruction List This chapter introduce s a list of in structions availa ble in programming. 3.1 Basic Instructions The basic instruction s are provided in th e following series. The table below s[...]
-
Page 73
71 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.1 Basi c Instru ctions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Com[...]
-
Page 74
72 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.2 Step Ladder Instructions 3.2 Step Ladder Instructions 3.3 Applied Instructions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number Applied instructi ons such as Arithme tic operati on, Rotatio n and Shift, Han dy instructi ons etc. are[...]
-
Page 75
73 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 76
74 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number Rotation an d Shift Operat ion 34 SFTR Bit Shift Right Section 11.5 35 SFT L Bit Shift Left [...]
-
Page 77
75 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 78
76 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number External FX De vice 75 ARWS Arrow Switc h – – – ––– Sectio n 15.6 76 ASC ASCII Code Da ta Input – – – ––– Sec[...]
-
Page 79
77 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 80
78 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number Data Operat ion 2 142 BTOW BYTE to WORD – – – *5 – – – – – Sectio n 19.3 143 UNI 4-bit Linking of Word Data – – – *5 – – – ?[...]
-
Page 81
79 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 82
80 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number Character St ring Control 202 $+ Link Char acter Stri ngs – – – ––––– Sectio n 26.3 203 LEN Character St ring Length Detection ––– ?[...]
-
Page 83
81 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 84
82 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3 Instruction List 3.3 Applied Instruct ions ... in Ascending Order of FNC Number External Dev ice Communicati on 271 IVD R I nverter Dr ive *6 ––––– Sect ion 30.2 272 IVR D I nverter Pa rameter Read *6 ?[...]
-
Page 85
83 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Com[...]
-
Page 86
84 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List High-speed co unter 1-phase 1-coun ting input Bi-direct ional (32 bits) (EEPROM keep) C235 to C245 − 2,147,483, 648 to +2,147, 483,647 coun ts Software co unter 1 phase: 60 kHz × 2 p oints, 10 k H[...]
-
Page 87
85 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Com[...]
-
Page 88
86 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List Data regi ster (32 bi ts when us ed in pair f orm) General type (16 b its) D0 to D127 128 points Section 4.9 EEPROM keep type (16 bits) D128 to D1099 972 po ints General type (16 b its) *1 D1100 to D[...]
-
Page 89
87 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Com[...]
-
Page 90
88 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.1 Device Number List High-speed co unter 1-phase 1-coun ting input Bi-direct ional (32 bits) C235 to C245 8 points max imum can be use d among C235 to C255 [latched (battery back ed) type]. The setti ng can be ch anged b[...]
-
Page 91
89 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.2 I/O Relays [X, Y] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Comp[...]
-
Page 92
90 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.2 I/O Relays [X, Y] 4.2.2 Functions and roles Examples of termina l names and wiring (s ink input) are for the FX 3U Series PLC. The PLC outputs s ignals to external loads thr ough output ter minal s. Cont acts for exter[...]
-
Page 93
91 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.2 I/O Relays [X, Y] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Comp[...]
-
Page 94
92 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.3 Auxiliary Relay [M] 4.3 Auxiliary Relay [M] There are many auxiliary rela ys inside the PLC. Coils of au xiliary rela ys are driven by contacts of variou s devices inside the PLC in the same way as outp ut relays. Auxi[...]
-
Page 95
93 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.3 Auxiliary Relay [M] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Co[...]
-
Page 96
94 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.4 State Relay [S] 4.4 State Relay [S] State relays (S) are im portant devices to program stepping type process control si mply, and combined w ith the step ladder instructio n STL. State relays can be used in the SFC (se[...]
-
Page 97
95 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.4 State Relay [S] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compar[...]
-
Page 98
96 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.4 State Relay [S] 3. Annunciator type Annunciator type state rel ays can be used as outp uts for external fault diagnosis . For example, w hen an extern al fault diagnosi s circuit shown in th e figure bel ow is created [...]
-
Page 99
97 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.5 Timer [T] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 F[...]
-
Page 100
98 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.5 Timer [T] 2. Retentiv e type When the drive input X00 1 of the timer coil T250 turns ON, the current value counte r for T250 adds and counts cloc k pulses of 100 ms. When the co unted value becomes eq uivalent t o the [...]
-
Page 101
99 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.5 Timer [T] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 F[...]
-
Page 102
100 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.5 Timer [T] 4.5.6 Program examples [off-delay timer and flicker timer] Off-delay timer Flicker timer (blink) In addition, the flicker operatio n can be performed by the ALT (FNC 66) instruction. Multi-timer by the appli[...]
-
Page 103
101 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.5 Timer [T] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 [...]
-
Page 104
102 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.6 Count er [C] 4.6 Counter [C] 4.6.1 Numbers of counters The table below shows counter (C) numbers. (Nu mbers are assigne d in decimal.) 1. FX 3S PLC → For high-s peed counte rs, refer to Section 4.7. 2. FX 3G /FX 3G [...]
-
Page 105
103 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.6 Count er [C] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare [...]
-
Page 106
104 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.6 Count er [C] 2. General type and latched (b attery backed) ty pe 32-bit bi-directiona l counters The valid set ran ge of 32-bit binary bi -directional counters is from − 2,147 ,483,648 to +2,147,483,647 (decimal con[...]
-
Page 107
105 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.6 Count er [C] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare [...]
-
Page 108
106 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.6 Count er [C] 2. Examples in applied ins tructions For the full use of counte rs as numeric devices, refer to the explanatio n of applied instructio ns later. 3. Caution on simultaneous instanc es of the ZRST instructi[...]
-
Page 109
107 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 110
108 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 5. High-speed counter dev ice list *1. C248 and C253 are usually used as cou nters having reset input, but can be used as counters C2 48 (OP) and C253 (OP) not having rese[...]
-
Page 111
109 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 112
110 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 4.7.3 Handling of high-speed counters High-speed coun ters in FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs operat e in the same w ay as high -speed coun ters in FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs. For details, ref[...]
-
Page 113
111 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 114
112 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 4.7.7 Response frequency of high-speed coun ters 1. Response frequency and overall frequency When any of the foll owing functi ons/instruct ions is used, th e overall freq[...]
-
Page 115
113 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 116
114 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 4.7.8 Cautions on use • For a contact to dr ive the coil of a high -speed coun ter, use a co ntact which i s normally ON during hig h-speed counting . • If the operati[...]
-
Page 117
115 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.7 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX3S/FX3G/FX3GC PLCs) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 118
116 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8 High-Speed Counter [C] (FX 3U /FX 3UC PLC) High-speed coun ter only availabl e in DC input type mai n units. 4.8.1 Types and device numbers of high-speed counters 1. Types [...]
-
Page 119
117 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 120
118 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8.2 Input assignment for h igh-speed counters Inputs X00 0 to X007 a re assigned as shown i n the table below accord ing to each high-speed counter nu mber. When a high-speed[...]
-
Page 121
119 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 122
120 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 2. 1-phase 2-coun t input These coun ters are 32 -bit binary bi-directi onal coun ters, and the operatio n of the ou tput contac t for the c urrent value is equivalent to that [...]
-
Page 123
121 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 124
122 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8.5 Related devices 1. Devices used to switch t he counting direction of 1- phase 1-count input cou nters 2. Devices used to che ck the counting dire ction of 1-phase 2 -coun[...]
-
Page 125
123 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 126
124 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8.8 How to use 2-phase 2-count input counters C251 to C255 with 4 edge counting For the 2-phase 2-coun t input counte rs C251 to C255, the edge c ount is usually set to 1. By[...]
-
Page 127
125 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 128
126 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8.10 Response frequency of high-spe ed counters 1. Response frequency of hardware counters The table below shows the maximum response frequency of hardware counters. When har[...]
-
Page 129
127 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 130
128 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 4.8.11 Cautions on use • For a contact to dr ive the coil of a high -speed coun ter, use a co ntact which i s normally ON during hig h-speed counting . • If the operation o[...]
-
Page 131
129 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.8 High-Speed Count er [C] (FX3U/FX3UC PLC) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC[...]
-
Page 132
130 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 4.9 Data Register and File Register [D] Data registers are device s for storing numeric data . File regi sters are handled as the initial values of data registers. Each data re gis[...]
-
Page 133
131 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-F[...]
-
Page 134
132 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 4.9.3 Functions and operation exam ples of data registers Data registers are devices for sto ring numeric data. Each data register stores 16-bit data (whose most si gnifi cant bit [...]
-
Page 135
133 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-F[...]
-
Page 136
134 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 4.9.4 Functions and operation exam ples of file registers A file regi ster is a d evice for se tting the in itial valu e of a data register wit h the same n umber. Each file re gis[...]
-
Page 137
135 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-F[...]
-
Page 138
136 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 3. Data register → File register <writing by BMOV (F NC 15) instruction> When a file register (D1000 or later) is speci fied for the destina tion of BMOV (FNC 15) in stru c[...]
-
Page 139
137 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.9 Data Register and File Regi ster [D] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-F[...]
-
Page 140
138 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] Extension regi sters (R) are the extended form of da ta registers (D). The contents of extens ion r[...]
-
Page 141
139 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pr[...]
-
Page 142
140 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 4.10.5 Functions and operati on examples of extension registers Extension regi sters can be used in vario us controls with numeric data the same as data registe[...]
-
Page 143
141 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pr[...]
-
Page 144
142 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] b) FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs 2. Sectors of extensio n registers and extension file registers In FX 3U /FX 3UC PL Cs, extension registers and extension file register s [...]
-
Page 145
143 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pr[...]
-
Page 146
144 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 4.10.8 Registration of data in extension registers and extension file registers This subsection ex plains the operating pro cedures of GX Works2. → For detail[...]
-
Page 147
145 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pr[...]
-
Page 148
146 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 3 Setting the data 1. Select [Edit] → [Input Device] to open the Input Device dialog box. 2. Set the "Device", "Rang e", "D isplay Mo[...]
-
Page 149
147 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.10 Extension Register [R] and Extension File Register [ER] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pr[...]
-
Page 150
148 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.11 Index Regis ter [V and Z] 4.11 Index Register [V and Z] Index registers can be used in the same way as of data registers. But they are special register s since they can change the contents of device numbers and numer[...]
-
Page 151
149 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.12 Pointer [P and I] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Co[...]
-
Page 152
150 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.12 Pointer [P and I] • Role of pointer P63 for jump to th e END step P63 is a special poi nter for jumping to th e END step when the CJ (FNC 00) instru ction is executed . Note that a program error will occur when P63[...]
-
Page 153
151 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.12 Pointer [P and I] 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Co[...]
-
Page 154
152 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 4 Devices in De tail 4.12 Pointer [P and I] Operations 3. Pointers for counter interrup t: 6 points *1 → For details on co unter interrup t function, refer to Section 36.6. The PLC exe cutes an i nterrupt rout ine based on the comp arison r[...]
-
Page 155
153 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.1 Numeric Values Handled in PLC (Octal, Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Numbers) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6[...]
-
Page 156
154 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.1 Numeric Values Handled in PLC (Octal, Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Numbers) 5.1.2 Conversion of numeric values Numeric values handl ed in FX PLCs can be con verted as shown in th e[...]
-
Page 157
155 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.1 Numeric Values Handled in PLC (Octal, Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Numbers) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6[...]
-
Page 158
156 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.1 Numeric Values Handled in PLC (Octal, Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Numbers) Scientific notation (real number) Because bin ary floating point (real number ) is difficult to understa[...]
-
Page 159
157 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.2 Specification of Consta nts K, H and E (Decimal, Hexadecimal and Real Number) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant [...]
-
Page 160
158 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.3 Character Strings 5.3 Character Strings Charact er strings are c lassified into characte r string constan ts which di rectly specif y character strings in op erands in applied instr[...]
-
Page 161
159 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.4 Specification of Digits for Bit Devices (Kn[ ]***) 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basi[...]
-
Page 162
160 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.5 Bit Specification of a Word Device (D[ ].b) 5.5 Bit Specification of a Word Device (D[ ].b) By specifying a bit of a word d evice, the specified b it can be used as bit data. When s[...]
-
Page 163
161 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.7 Indexing 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9[...]
-
Page 164
162 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.7 Indexing 5.7.2 Indexing in applied instructions Expression of applied instructions all owing indexing In the explanation of applied instruction s, " " is added t o the[...]
-
Page 165
163 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.7 Indexing 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9[...]
-
Page 166
164 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.7 Indexing 5.7.3 Indexing example for instruction with limited number of use. By modifyi ng the target device number s using inde x regi sters V and Z, the target device numbers can b[...]
-
Page 167
165 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 5 How to Specify Devices an d Constants to Inst ructions 5.7 Indexing 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9[...]
-
Page 168
166 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.1 How to Read Explana tion of Instructio ns 6. What to Understand before Programming This chapter explai ns the I/O processing, rela tionship amon g instructions and p rogramming method which sh oul[...]
-
Page 169
167 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.1 How to Read Explana tion of Instructio ns 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FN[...]
-
Page 170
168 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.1 How to Read Explana tion of Instructio ns Applicable devices Devices wh ich can be specifi ed in operands of instructi ons are shown. When a device supports an instruction, " " is ad[...]
-
Page 171
169 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.2 Cautions on Creati on of Fundamental Programs 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC0[...]
-
Page 172
170 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.2 Cautions on Creati on of Fundamental Programs 6.2.2 Double output (double coil) operati on and countermeasures 1. Operation of doub le outputs When a coil g ives doub le outputs (double coi ls) in[...]
-
Page 173
171 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.3 I/O Processing and Response Del ay 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 174
172 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.4 Mutual Rel ationship Among Program Flow Control Instruct ions 6.4 Mutual Relationship Among Progr am Flow Control Instructions The table below show s the mutual relation ship among various pr ogra[...]
-
Page 175
173 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.4 Mutual Rel ationship Among Program Flow Control Instruct ions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic In[...]
-
Page 176
174 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 6.5 General Rules for App lied Instructions 6.5.1 Expression and operation type of applied instructions Instructions and operands - Both a func tion number [...]
-
Page 177
175 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC0[...]
-
Page 178
176 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 6.5.2 Handling of general flags In some types of applied instructions, the following flags operate: Examples: M8020: Zero flag M8021: Borrow flag M8022: Car[...]
-
Page 179
177 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC0[...]
-
Page 180
178 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 6.5.3 Handling of operation error flag When there is an error in the applied instru ction configurat ion, target devic e or target device numbe r range and [...]
-
Page 181
179 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.5 General Rules for Applied Instruct ions 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC0[...]
-
Page 182
180 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 6 What to Unders tand before Pro gramming 6.6 Symbolic informati on storage and block password 6.6 Symbolic information storage and block password 6.6.1 Storage of symbolic inform ation The FX 3U /FX 3UC PL C Ver. 3.00 or later can store symb[...]
-
Page 183
181 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FNC20-FNC29 Ar[...]
-
Page 184
182 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction Connection Instruction ANB AND Block Serial conn ection of mu ltiple parallel cir cuits − Sect ion 7.7 ORB OR Block Parallel co nnection of multiple contac t circuits − Section 7.6 MPS Memory Point Store Stores the cu[...]
-
Page 185
183 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.1 LD, LDI 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FN[...]
-
Page 186
184 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.1 LD, LDI 2. LDI instruction (initial logi cal operation, NC contact ty pe) 3. Indexing *1 Devices used in LD and LDI i nstructions allow ind exing with index regi sters (V and Z). (State relays (S), special auxiliary r[...]
-
Page 187
185 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.2 OUT 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FNC20-[...]
-
Page 188
186 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.2 OUT 2. When a timer or counter is used The set value is required after OUT instruction for the counting coil of a timer or co unter. The set value can be specified directl y by a decimal numbe r (K) or indirectly u si[...]
-
Page 189
187 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.2 OUT 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FNC20-[...]
-
Page 190
188 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.3 AND, ANI 7.3 AND, ANI Outline AND and ANI instru ctions connect one co ntact in series. The number of contacts conn ected in series is not limited , so AND and ANI instructio ns can be used consec utively as many time[...]
-
Page 191
189 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.3 AND, ANI 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 F[...]
-
Page 192
190 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.3 AND, ANI Program examples X005 Y005 T0 Circuit program List program K30 X000 Y003 AND instruction LD AND OUT LD ANI OUT AND OUT (SP) LD ANI OUT 0000 0001 0002 0003 0004 0005 0006 0007 0010 001 1 0012 X000 X001 Y003 X0[...]
-
Page 193
191 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.4 OR, ORI 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FN[...]
-
Page 194
192 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.4 OR, ORI 2. ORI instruction (parallel connect ion of NC (normally closed ) contacts) 3. Relationship with ANB instruction The parallel connection by OR or ORI instruction is connected to the p receding LD or LDI instru[...]
-
Page 195
193 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.4 OR, ORI 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FN[...]
-
Page 196
194 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF Outline LDP, ANDP, and ORP instructions for contacts detect the rising edge, and be come acti ve during one op eration cycle only at th e rising e dge [...]
-
Page 197
195 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 M[...]
-
Page 198
196 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 2. LDF, AN DF, and ORF instru ctions (initial logical operation of fal ling/trailing edge pulse, serial connection of falling/trailing e dge pulse, and parallel connectio n of falling/tr[...]
-
Page 199
197 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 M[...]
-
Page 200
198 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 5. Differences in the operation ca used by auxiliary relay (M) numbers When an auxiliary relay (M) is speci fied as a device in LDP, LD F, ANDP, ANDF, ORP and ORF instructions, the opera[...]
-
Page 201
199 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.5 LDP, LDF, ANDP, ANDF, ORP, ORF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 M[...]
-
Page 202
200 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.6 ORB 7.6 ORB Outline A circuit in which two or more contacts are connected in serie s is called serial circui t block. 1. Instruction format 2. Applicab le device s Explanation of function and operation 1. ORB instruct[...]
-
Page 203
201 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.7 ANB 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FNC20-[...]
-
Page 204
202 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.8 MPS, MRD, MPP 7.8 MPS, MRD, MPP Outline FX 3G, FX 3U FX 3GC and FX 3UC PLCs have 11 memories call ed "Stack" whi ch store the i ntermediate re sult (ON or OFF ) of operations. 1. Instruction format 2. Applic[...]
-
Page 205
203 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.8 MPS, MRD, MPP 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare[...]
-
Page 206
204 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.8 MPS, MRD, MPP 3) Program exampl e 3: Two stacks 4) Program example 4: Fo ur stacks In programming a circuit on the upper si de, it is ne cessary to MPS i nstruction th ree times. By changing the circuit on the upper s[...]
-
Page 207
205 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.9 MC, MCR 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FN[...]
-
Page 208
206 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.9 MC, MCR Caution 1. A circuit error (Error code: 6611) occurs when an inst ruction connected the bus line (such as LD and LDI) is not present just after the MC instruction. 2. Cautions on writing du ring RUN The PLC ca[...]
-
Page 209
207 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.9 MC, MCR 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FN[...]
-
Page 210
208 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.10 INV 7.10 INV Outline 1. Instruction Format INV instruction i nverts the operation resul t up to just be fore INV inst ruction, an d does not r equire de vice number specification. 2. Applicab le device s Explanation [...]
-
Page 211
209 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.11 MEP, MEF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 [...]
-
Page 212
210 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.11 MEP, MEF Caution 1. MEP and MEF instr uctions may not operat e normally if the indexed cont act is modified and changed to pulses by sub-routine programs, the FOR and NEXT instructions, e tc. 2. As the MEP and MEF in[...]
-
Page 213
211 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.12 PLS, PLF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 [...]
-
Page 214
212 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.12 PLS, PLF 3. Output drive side The following two circuits result the same operatio n. In each case, M0 is ON during only one oper ation cycle when X000 cha nges from OFF to ON. In each case, MOV instruc tion is execut[...]
-
Page 215
213 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.12 PLS, PLF 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 [...]
-
Page 216
214 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.13 SET, RST 7.13 SET, RST Outline 1) Setting a bit device (SET i nst ruction (set bit device l atch ON)) When the command input turns ON, SET in struction sets to ON an output relay (Y), auxi liary relay (M), state rela[...]
-
Page 217
215 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.13 SET, RST 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 [...]
-
Page 218
216 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.13 SET, RST Cautions on u sing RST instruc tion for a jumped program, subrou tine program or i nterrupt program When RST instruction for a timer or counter is executed in a jumped program, subroutine program or interrup[...]
-
Page 219
217 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.14 NOP 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 FNC10-FNC19 Move & Compare 10 FNC20[...]
-
Page 220
218 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.15 END 7.15 END Outline END instruction sp ecifies the end of a program. (Do not write the END instruction in the mid dle of a program.) 1. Instruction format 2. Applicab le device s Explanation of function and operatio[...]
-
Page 221
219 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7 Basic Instru ction 7.16 Number of Inst ruction Steps and Speci fied Devices 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Progra[...]
-
Page 222
220 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8. Program Flow – FNC 00 to FNC 09 FNC 00 to FNC 09 prov ide instructions mai nly relate d to control flow of sequence programs s uch as conditiona l program execution and prio rity processing. FNC No. [...]
-
Page 223
221 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 224
222 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump Cautions 1. Relationship between the label input position and the list progra m The figure belo w shows programming of a label. When creating a circuit program, move t[...]
-
Page 225
223 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 226
224 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump Program example 1. When a jump is necessary afte r OFF processing In one op eration cycl e after X023 changes from OFF to ON, the CJ P7 instru ction become s valid. By[...]
-
Page 227
225 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 228
226 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump 2. Circuit example 2 for explai ning operations (when only an RST instruct ion for a timer or counter is jumped) When X011 turns ON while th e RST instru ction for th [...]
-
Page 229
227 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.1 FNC 00 – CJ / Conditional Jump 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 230
228 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.2 FNC 01 – CALL / Call Subroutine 8.2 FNC 01 – CALL / Call Subroutine Outline This instruction calls and e xecutes a program which should be processe d commonly in a sequenc e program. This instruct[...]
-
Page 231
229 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.2 FNC 01 – CALL / Call Subroutine 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program [...]
-
Page 232
230 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.2 FNC 01 – CALL / Call Subroutine 8.2.1 Cautions on subroutines and inte rrupt routines This section expl ains cautions on creati ng pr ograms in subroutines and in terrupt routine s. The explan ation[...]
-
Page 233
231 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.2 FNC 01 – CALL / Call Subroutine 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program [...]
-
Page 234
232 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.3 FNC 02 – SRET / Subroutine Return 8.3 FNC 02 – SRET / Subroutine Return Outline This instruc tion returns the prog ram executio n from a subroutine to the main program. 1. Instruction format 2. Se[...]
-
Page 235
233 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.4 FNC 03 – IRET / In terrupt Re turn 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Progr[...]
-
Page 236
234 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.4 FNC 03 – IRET / In terrupt Re turn Program example Interrup ts are usuall y disable d in PLCs. Use EI instruction to enab le interrupts. When X000 tu rns ON while t he main prog ram is execute d, in[...]
-
Page 237
235 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.5 FNC 04 – EI / Enable Int errupt 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program [...]
-
Page 238
236 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.6 FNC 05 – DI / Disable Interrupt 8.6 FNC 05 – DI / Disable Interrupt Outline This instruction disables interrupts after interrupts w ere enabled by EI (F NC 04) instruction. 1. Instruction format 2[...]
-
Page 239
237 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.7 FNC 06 – FEND / Ma in Routine Program End 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC0[...]
-
Page 240
238 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.7 FNC 06 – FEND / Ma in Routine Program End 2. In the case of CALL instruction Cautions 1. When FEND instruction is programmed two or more times Put a subr outine pr ogram or inte rrupt routi ne progr[...]
-
Page 241
239 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.8 FNC 07 – WDT / Watchdog Timer Refre sh 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 P[...]
-
Page 242
240 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.8 FNC 07 – WDT / Watchdog Timer Refre sh 2. The watchdog timer time can be changed. → For details on changing watchdog timer time, refe r to Subsecti on 37.2.2. By overwriting the contents of D800 0[...]
-
Page 243
241 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.9 FNC 08 – FOR / Start a FOR/NEXT Loop 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 244
242 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.10 FNC 09 – NEXT / End a FOR/NEXT Loop 8.10 FNC 09 – NEXT / End a FOR/NEXT Loop Outline NEXT instru ction spe cifies the en d position of the loo p. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le [...]
-
Page 245
243 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 8 Program Fl ow – FNC 0 0 to FNC 09 8.10 FNC 09 – NEXT / End a FOR/NEXT Loop 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Pro[...]
-
Page 246
244 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9. Move and Compare – FNC 10 to FNC 19 FNC 10 to FN C 19 provide fun damenta l data processi ng inst ru ctions such as data transfer a nd data comparison which are regarded as most import ant in appl[...]
-
Page 247
245 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.1 FNC 10 – CMP / Compare 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9[...]
-
Page 248
246 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.1 FNC 10 – CMP / Compare 2. 32-bit operation (DCMP and DCMPP) The comparison value [ +1, ] and the com parison source [ +1, ] are compared with ea ch other. According to the result (sm aller, equal[...]
-
Page 249
247 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.2 FNC 11 – ZCP / Zone Compare 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program F[...]
-
Page 250
248 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.2 FNC 11 – ZCP / Zone Compare 2. 32-bit operation (DZCP and DZCPP) The lower compariso n value [ +1, ] and up per comparison value [ +1, ] are compared with th e comparison source [ +1, ]. Accordin[...]
-
Page 251
249 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.3 FNC 12 – MOV / Mo ve 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 F[...]
-
Page 252
250 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.3 FNC 12 – MOV / Mo ve When a word device is specified The word device transfers 1 point. 2. 32-bit operation (DMOV and DMOVP) The content s of the tra nsfer source [ +1, ] are t ransferred t o the[...]
-
Page 253
251 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.3 FNC 12 – MOV / Mo ve 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow 9 F[...]
-
Page 254
252 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.4 FNC 13 – SMOV / Shift Move 9.4 FNC 13 – SMOV / Shift Move Outline This instruction distributes and comp oses data in units of digit (4 bits). 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le de[...]
-
Page 255
253 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.4 FNC 13 – SMOV / Shift Move 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Fl[...]
-
Page 256
254 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.5 FNC 14 – CML / Complement 9.5 FNC 14 – CML / Complement Outline This instru ction inve rts data in units of b it, and then transfers ( copies) the i nverted da ta. 1. Instruction format 2. Set [...]
-
Page 257
255 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.5 FNC 14 – CML / Complement 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flo[...]
-
Page 258
256 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.6 FNC 15 – BMOV / Block Move 9.6 FNC 15 – BMOV / Block Move Outline This instruction transfers (copies) a spe cified number of data all at once. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le d[...]
-
Page 259
257 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.6 FNC 15 – BMOV / Block Move 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Fl[...]
-
Page 260
258 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.6 FNC 15 – BMOV / Block Move 9.6.1 Function of transfer between file registe rs and data registers BMOV (FNC 15) instruction ha s a special function for file registers (D1000 and later). → For de[...]
-
Page 261
259 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.6 FNC 15 – BMOV / Block Move 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Fl[...]
-
Page 262
260 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.7 FNC 16 – FMOV / Fill Move 9.7 FNC 16 – FMOV / Fill Move Outline This instruction transfers same data to speci fied number of devices . 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le device s [...]
-
Page 263
261 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.7 FNC 16 – FMOV / Fill Move 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flo[...]
-
Page 264
262 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.8 FNC 17 – XCH / Exchange 9.8 FNC 17 – XCH / Exchange Outline This instruction exchan ges data between two devices. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le device s Explanation of functi[...]
-
Page 265
263 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.8 FNC 17 – XCH / Exchange 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 Program Flow [...]
-
Page 266
264 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.9 FNC 18 – BCD / Conversion to Binary Coded De cimal 9.9 FNC 18 – BCD / Conversion to Binary Coded Decimal Outline This instruction converts bi nary (BIN) da ta into binary-cod ed decimal (BCD) d[...]
-
Page 267
265 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.9 FNC 18 – BCD / Conversion to Binary Coded De cimal 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction [...]
-
Page 268
266 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.9 FNC 18 – BCD / Conversion to Binary Coded De cimal Program examples 1. When the seven-segment display unit has 1 digit 2. When the seven-segment display unit has 2 to 4 digit s 3. When the seven-[...]
-
Page 269
267 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.10 FNC 19 – BIN / Conversion to Binary 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 [...]
-
Page 270
268 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.10 FNC 19 – BIN / Conversion to Binary 2. 32-bit o peration (DBIN and DBINP) This instructio n converts the bina ry-coded decimal (BC D) data of [ +1, ] into binary (BIN) da ta, and transfer s the [...]
-
Page 271
269 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 9 Move and Compare – FN C 10 to FNC 19 9.10 FNC 19 – BIN / Conversion to Binary 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Basic Instruction 8 FNC00-FNC09 [...]
-
Page 272
270 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10. Arithmetic and Logical Operation ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 20 to FNC 29 FNC 20 to FNC 29 provide instructions for arithmetic o perations and logi cal op[...]
-
Page 273
271 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.1 FNC 20 – ADD / Addition 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Bas[...]
-
Page 274
272 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.1 FNC 20 – ADD / Addition Related devices 1. Relationship between the fl ag operation and the sign (pos itive or negative) of a numeric value → For the f[...]
-
Page 275
273 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.2 FNC 21 – SUB / Subtraction 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 [...]
-
Page 276
274 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.2 FNC 21 – SUB / Subtraction Related devices 1. Relationship between the fl ag operation and the sign (pos itive or negative) of a numeric value → For th[...]
-
Page 277
275 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.3 FNC 22 – MUL / Multiplication 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming[...]
-
Page 278
276 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.3 FNC 22 – MUL / Multiplication • When a digit (K1 to K8) is specified for [ +1, ] A digit can be speci fied rangin g from K1 to K8 . For exampl e, when [...]
-
Page 279
277 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.3 FNC 22 – MUL / Multiplication 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming[...]
-
Page 280
278 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.4 FNC 23 – DIV / Division 10.4 FNC 23 – DIV / Divisi on Outline This ins truction ex ecutes di vision by two values t o obtain the result (A ÷ B = C ...[...]
-
Page 281
279 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.4 FNC 23 – DIV / Division 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Bas[...]
-
Page 282
280 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.4 FNC 23 – DIV / Division Program examples 1. 16-bit o peration 2. 32-bit o peration Function Changes According to Versi ons The function of the FNC 23 ins[...]
-
Page 283
281 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.5 FNC 24 – INC / Increment 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Ba[...]
-
Page 284
282 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.5 FNC 24 – INC / Increment Program example X010 M 1 X011 FNC 12 MOVP K 0 Z FNC 18 BCDP C 0Z K4Y000 FNC 24 INCP Z FNC 10 CMPP K 10 Z M 0 0 → (Z) (C 0Z) ?[...]
-
Page 285
283 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.6 FNC 25 – DEC / Decrement 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Ba[...]
-
Page 286
284 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.7 FNC 26 – WAND / Logical Word AND 10.7 FNC 26 – WAND / Logical Word AND Outline This instruction executes the logical product (AND) operation of two num[...]
-
Page 287
285 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.7 FNC 26 – WAND / Logical Word AND 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programm[...]
-
Page 288
286 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.8 FNC 27 – WOR / Logical Word OR 10.8 FNC 27 – WOR / Logical Word OR Outline This instruction executes the lo gical sum (OR) operation of two numeri c va[...]
-
Page 289
287 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.8 FNC 27 – WOR / Logical Word OR 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programmin[...]
-
Page 290
288 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.9 FNC 28 – WXOR / Logical Excl usive OR 10.9 FNC 28 – WXOR / Logical Exclusive OR Outline This instruction executes the exclusive logical sum (XOR) opera[...]
-
Page 291
289 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.9 FNC 28 – WXOR / Logical Excl usive OR 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Pro[...]
-
Page 292
290 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.10 FNC 29 – NEG / Negation 10.10 FNC 29 – NEG / Negation Outline This instru ction obta ins the compl ement of a numeric value (by inver ting each bit an[...]
-
Page 293
291 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 10 Arithmetic and Lo gical Operatio n ( + , − , × , ÷ ) – FNC 2 0 to FNC 29 10.10 FNC 29 – NEG / Negation 1 Introduction 2 Overview 3 Instruction List 4 Devices in Detail 5 Specified the Device & Constant 6 Before Programming 7 Ba[...]
-
Page 294
292 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11. Rotation and Shift Operation – FNC 30 to FNC 39 FNC 30 to FNC 3 9 provide in structions for r otating and sh ifti ng bit data and word da ta in sp ecified di rections. FNC No. Mnemon[...]
-
Page 295
293 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.1 FNC 30 – ROR / Rotation Right 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 296
294 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.1 FNC 30 – ROR / Rotation Right 2. 32-bit o peration (DROR and DRORP) "n" bits out of 32 bits of [ +1, ] are rotated rig htward. • The final bit is st ored in the carry fl[...]
-
Page 297
295 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.2 FNC 31 – ROL / Rotation Left 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ext[...]
-
Page 298
296 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.2 FNC 31 – ROL / Rotation Left 2. 32-bit operation (DROL and DROLP) "n" bits out of 32 bits of [ +1, ] are rota ted leftward. • The final bit is st ored in the carry flag [...]
-
Page 299
297 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.3 FNC 32 – RCR / Rotation Right with Carry 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC[...]
-
Page 300
298 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.3 FNC 32 – RCR / Rotation Right with Carry 2. 32-bit operation (DRCR and DRCRP) "n" bits out of 32 bits of [ +1, ] and 1 b it (carry flag M8022) are rota ted rightward. Rela[...]
-
Page 301
299 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.4 FNC 33 – RCL / Rotation Left with Carry 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC7[...]
-
Page 302
300 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.4 FNC 33 – RCL / Rotation Left with Carry 2. 32-bit operation (DRCL and DRCLP) "n" bits out of 32 bits of [ +1, ] and 1 b it (carry flag M8022) are rota ted leftward . Relat[...]
-
Page 303
301 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.5 FNC 34 – SFTR / Bit Shift Right 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 304
302 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.5 FNC 34 – SFTR / Bit Shift Right Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit operation (SFTR and SFTRP) For "n1" bits (shift regi ster length) starting from , "n 2[...]
-
Page 305
303 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.6 FNC 35 – SFTL / Bit Shift Left 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 E[...]
-
Page 306
304 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.6 FNC 35 – SFTL / Bit Shift Left Caution Note that "n2" bits are shifted every time the command inpu t turns from OFF to ON in the SFTLP i nstruction, but that "n2"[...]
-
Page 307
305 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.6 FNC 35 – SFTL / Bit Shift Left 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 E[...]
-
Page 308
306 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.7 FNC 36 – WSFR / Word Shift Right 11.7 FNC 36 – WSFR / Word Shift Right Outline This instructio n shifts word de vices with "n1" da ta length righ tward by "n2"[...]
-
Page 309
307 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.7 FNC 36 – WSFR / Word Shift Right 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 310
308 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.8 FNC 37 – WSFL / Word Shift Left 11.8 FNC 37 – WSFL / Word Shift Left Outline This instructio n shifts the word data info rmation leftwa rd by the specifi ed number of wo rds. 1. I[...]
-
Page 311
309 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.8 FNC 37 – WSFL / Word Shift Left 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 312
310 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.9 FNC 38 – SFWR / Shift Write [FIFO/FILO Control] 11.9 FNC 38 – SFWR / Shift Write [FIFO/FILO Control] Outline This instruction writes data for first-in first- out (FIFO) and last-i[...]
-
Page 313
311 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.9 FNC 38 – SFWR / Shift Write [FIFO/FILO Control] 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 314
312 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.9 FNC 38 – SFWR / Shift Write [FIFO/FILO Control] Program example 1. Example of first-in first- out control → For a program ex ample of FILO, refer to Sectio n 27.3. In the example [...]
-
Page 315
313 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.10 FNC 39 – SFRD / Shift Read [FIFO Control] 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 316
314 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 11 Rotation and Shift Op eration – FNC 30 to FNC 39 11.10 FNC 39 – SFRD / Shift Read [FIFO Control] 1) When the command input turns ON, the contents of +1 are transferred (read) to . 2) Accompanied by this tran sfer, the contents of th e [...]
-
Page 317
315 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 External FX Dev[...]
-
Page 318
316 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset Outline This instruction resets devices located in a zo ne betwee n two specified device s at one time. Use this ins truction fo r res[...]
-
Page 319
317 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Dev[...]
-
Page 320
318 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset 3. Caution for simultaneous insta nces of the ZRST instruction and the PLS instruct ion The ZRST instructio n resets the last stage for the PL S instruction and P LF in[...]
-
Page 321
319 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.1 FNC 40 – ZRST / Zone Reset 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Dev[...]
-
Page 322
320 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.2 FNC 41 – DECO / Decode 12.2 FNC 41 – DECO / Decode Outline This instruction converts numeric data into ON bit. A bit number which is set t o ON by th is instruction indicates a numeric value. 1[...]
-
Page 323
321 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.2 FNC 41 – DECO / Decode 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device [...]
-
Page 324
322 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.2 FNC 41 – DECO / Decode Program example 1. When setting bit devices to ON according to the value of a data register The value of D0 (whose current va lue is "14" in this e xample) is dec[...]
-
Page 325
323 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.3 FNC 42 – ENCO / Encode 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device [...]
-
Page 326
324 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.3 FNC 42 – ENCO / Encode 2) When is a word dev ice (1 ≤ n ≤ 4) ON bit positions amo ng "2 n " bits (1 ≤ n ≤ 4) from a de vice specif ied in are encoded to . -The encoding result o[...]
-
Page 327
325 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.4 FNC 43 – SUM / Sum of Active Bits 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX [...]
-
Page 328
326 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.4 FNC 43 – SUM / Sum of Active Bits 2. 32-bit op eration (DSU M and DSUM P) The number of bits in the ON status in [ +1, ] is coun ted, and st ored to . • The number of bits i n the ON stat us ar[...]
-
Page 329
327 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.4 FNC 43 – SUM / Sum of Active Bits 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX [...]
-
Page 330
328 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.5 FNC 44 – BON / Check Specified Bit Status 12.5 FNC 44 – BON / C heck Specified Bit Status Outline This instru ction che cks whether a specified b it positi on in a spec ified dev ice is ON or O[...]
-
Page 331
329 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.5 FNC 44 – BON / Check Specified Bit Status 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 332
330 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.6 FNC 45 – MEAN / Mean 12.6 FNC 45 – MEAN / Mean Outline This instru ction obta ins the mean value of d ata. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab le device s S 1: This function is su ppo[...]
-
Page 333
331 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.6 FNC 45 – MEAN / Mean 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16[...]
-
Page 334
332 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.7 FNC 46 – ANS / Timed Annunciator Set 12.7 FNC 46 – ANS / Timed Annunciator Set Outline This instru ction sets a state rela y as an an nunciator ( S900 to S999 ). 1. Instruction format 2. Set da[...]
-
Page 335
333 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.7 FNC 46 – ANS / Timed Annunciator Set 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 336
334 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.8 FNC 47 – ANR / Annunciator Reset 12.8 FNC 47 – ANR / Annunciator Reset Outline This instruction resets an annunciator (S9 00 to S9 99) in the ON status wi th the smallest number. 1. Instruction[...]
-
Page 337
335 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.9 FNC 48 – SQR / Square Root 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Dev[...]
-
Page 338
336 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.10 FNC 49 – FLT / Conversion to Floa ting Point 12.10 FNC 49 – FLT / Conver sion to Floating Point Outline This instruction converts a bi nary integer into a binary fl oating point (real number).[...]
-
Page 339
337 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 12 Data Operation – FN C 40 to FNC 49 12.10 FNC 49 – FLT / Conversion to Floa ting Point 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 340
338 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13. High-Speed Processing – FNC 50 to FNC 59 FNC 50 to FNC 59 pro vide interrupt processi ng type high-sp eed i nstructions that execut e sequence control using the latest I/O information and[...]
-
Page 341
339 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.1 FNC 50 – REF / Refresh 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/[...]
-
Page 342
340 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.1 FNC 50 – REF / Refresh Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit operation (REF and REFP) 1) When refreshing outputs (Y) "n" points are refreshed from the output spe cifi[...]
-
Page 343
341 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.1 FNC 50 – REF / Refresh 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/[...]
-
Page 344
342 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.1 FNC 50 – REF / Refresh 13.1.1 What should be understood bef ore using the REF instruction 1. Changing the input fi lter The input filter val ue is determined by th e contents of D8020 (i[...]
-
Page 345
343 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.2 FNC 51 – REFF / Refresh and Filter Adjust 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 346
344 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.2 FNC 51 – REFF / Refresh and Filter Adjust Cautions 1. Setting the fi lter time "n" Set "n" within the range from K0 (H0) to K60 (H3C) [0 to 60 ms]. 2. Function of the[...]
-
Page 347
345 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.2 FNC 51 – REFF / Refresh and Filter Adjust 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 348
346 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.3 FNC 52 – MTR / Input Matrix 13.3 FNC 52 – MTR / Input Matrix Outline This instruction reads matrix inpu t as 8-point input × "n"-point output (transistor) in t he time divis[...]
-
Page 349
347 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.3 FNC 52 – MTR / Input Matrix 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 350
348 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.3 FNC 52 – MTR / Input Matrix Program example n=Three ou tputs (Y020, Y0 21 and Y022) are set to ON in turn repeatedly. Every time a n output is se t to ON, e ight inputs in the 1s t, 2n d[...]
-
Page 351
349 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.3 FNC 52 – MTR / Input Matrix 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 352
350 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / Hi gh-Speed Counter Set Outline This instruction com pares a value coun ted by a high-spee d counte r with a specified v alu[...]
-
Page 353
351 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC7[...]
-
Page 354
352 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 2) FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs When the H SCS instructio n is used in FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs, th e total fr equency o f each counter is affected. [...]
-
Page 355
353 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC7[...]
-
Page 356
354 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 4. Caution on the counting operation when the current value is changed An instruction for the high-speed counte r gives the comparison result when [...]
-
Page 357
355 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.4 FNC 53 – HSCS / High-Speed Counter Set 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC7[...]
-
Page 358
356 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.5 FNC 54 – HSCR / High-Speed Counte r Reset 13.5 FNC 54 – HSCR / Hi gh-Speed Counter Reset Outline This instruction co mpares the valu e counted by a h igh-speed counter w ith a specifie[...]
-
Page 359
357 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.5 FNC 54 – HSCR / High-Speed Counte r Reset 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 360
358 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.5 FNC 54 – HSCR / High-Speed Counte r Reset 2. Only 32-bit operation instructions are available. Because instructions fo r high-speed counte rs are dedicated to 32 bits , make sure to inpu[...]
-
Page 361
359 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 362
360 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare Comparison points Make sure that the comparison value 1 and the compari son value 2 have the follow ing relationship: [+ 1 , ] ≤ [+ 1 , [...]
-
Page 363
361 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 364
362 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 2. Device specific ation range Only high-speed coun ters (C235 to C255) can be specified as . 3. Only 32-bit operation instructions are av[...]
-
Page 365
363 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 366
364 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare Timing chart In the part [1] in the timing chart, Y01 0 remains OFF if th e current value of a high-speed coun ter (C235 in th e example b[...]
-
Page 367
365 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 368
366 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 2. Operation FNC 12 DMOV K123 D200 FNC 12 MOV H10 D202 M8002 FNC 12 MOV K1 D203 FNC 12 DMOV K234 D204 FNC 12 MOV H10 D206 FNC 12 MOV K0 D2[...]
-
Page 369
367 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 370
368 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 13.6.3 Frequency control mode (HSZ and PLSY instructions) (M8132) When the special au xiliary relay M8132 for d eclaring the frequency co [...]
-
Page 371
369 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 F[...]
-
Page 372
370 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.6 FNC 55 – HSZ / High-Speed Counter Zon e Compare Output pulse chara cteristics 1) Write prescribed data in advance to data registers co nstructin g the table as shown i n this pr ogram ex[...]
-
Page 373
371 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.7 FNC 56 – SPD / Speed Detection 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 374
372 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.7 FNC 56 – SPD / Speed Detection Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit o peration (SPD) The input pul se is counted only for × 1 ms. The measured value is stored in , th e prese[...]
-
Page 375
373 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.7 FNC 56 – SPD / Speed Detection 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 376
374 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.7 FNC 56 – SPD / Speed Detection Cautions 1. Input specification s of the input • An input device X000 to X007 specifie d as cannot overlap the followin g functions or instructions : - H[...]
-
Page 377
375 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.8 FNC 57 – PLSY / Pulse Y Output 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 378
376 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.8 FNC 57 – PLSY / Pulse Y Output 2. 32-bit operation (DPLSY) A pulse train at the frequency [ +1, ] is output by the quantity [ +1, ] from the output (Y) . • Specify the frequency in [ +[...]
-
Page 379
377 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.8 FNC 57 – PLSY / Pulse Y Output 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 380
378 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.8 FNC 57 – PLSY / Pulse Y Output 4. Handli ng of pulse ou tput terminals in FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC series main unit s The outputs Y0 00 and Y001 ar e the high-sp eed response [...]
-
Page 381
379 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.8 FNC 57 – PLSY / Pulse Y Output 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 382
380 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.9 FNC 58 – PWM / Pulse Width Modulation 13.9 FNC 58 – PWM / Pulse Width Modulation Outline This instruction outputs pul ses with a specified pe riod and ON duratio n. 1. Instruction form[...]
-
Page 383
381 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.9 FNC 58 – PWM / Pulse Width Modulation 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 384
382 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.9 FNC 58 – PWM / Pulse Width Modulation 4) When speci al high-spe ed output ada pters are connec ted, the same ou tput numbers in the main unit are a ssigned as shown i n the table below. [...]
-
Page 385
383 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.10 FNC 59 – PLSR / Acceleration/De celeration Setup 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15[...]
-
Page 386
384 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.10 FNC 59 – PLSR / Acceleration/De celeration Setup 2. 32-bit op eration (DPLSR) Pulses are output from the outpu t (Y) by the spe c ified n umber [ +1, ] with acceleration /deceleration t[...]
-
Page 387
385 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.10 FNC 59 – PLSR / Acceleration/De celeration Setup 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15[...]
-
Page 388
386 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.10 FNC 59 – PLSR / Acceleration/De celeration Setup 3. Handli ng of pulse ou tput terminals in FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC series main unit s The outputs Y000 an d Y001 are the hig[...]
-
Page 389
387 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 13 High-Spe ed Process ing – FNC 5 0 to FNC 59 13.10 FNC 59 – PLSR / Acceleration/De celeration Setup 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15[...]
-
Page 390
388 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14. Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FNC 69 FNC 60 to F NC 69 provide handy ins tructions w hich achiev e complicate d control i n a minimum se quence progr am. FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol Function Refere[...]
-
Page 391
389 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 392
390 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 1. Control of devices by switch operations (oc cupied devices) While the command input is ON, the following devices are automatically switched and controlled. Whi[...]
-
Page 393
391 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 394
392 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 14.1.2 Example of IST instruction introduction (example of workpiece transfer mechanism) 1. Operation mode 2. Transfer me chanism The upper left positi on is rega[...]
-
Page 395
393 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 396
394 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 4. Special auxiliary relay ( M) for the IST instruction Auxiliary relays (M) u sed in the IST i nstruction are cla ssified into tw o types. S ome auxiliary relay [...]
-
Page 397
395 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 398
396 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State c) Zero return operation mode Programming is n ot required when the zero re turn operati on mode is not p rovided. It is necessary to set M8 043 (zero return comp[...]
-
Page 399
397 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 400
398 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.1 FNC 60 – IST / Initia l State 6. List pr ogram The list program fo r the circuit diagram show n on the previous page is as shown below : 0 LD X 004 1 AND X 002 2 ANI Y 001 3 OUT M 8044 5 LD M8[...]
-
Page 401
399 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.2 FNC 61 – SER / Search a Data Stack 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External[...]
-
Page 402
400 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.2 FNC 61 – SER / Search a Data Stack 2) Operation example a) E xample of search res ult table configuratio n and data b) Search result ta ble 2. 32-bit operation (DSER and DSERP) In "n"[...]
-
Page 403
401 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.2 FNC 61 – SER / Search a Data Stack 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External[...]
-
Page 404
402 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.3 FNC 62 – ABSD / Absolute Drum Sequencer 14.3 FNC 62 – ABSD / Abso lute Drum Sequencer Outline This instruction creates many output patterns corresponding to the current value of a co unter. [...]
-
Page 405
403 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.3 FNC 62 – ABSD / Absolute Drum Sequencer 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ext[...]
-
Page 406
404 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.3 FNC 62 – ABSD / Absolute Drum Sequencer 1) Write the followin g data to [ , +1] to [ +4n-2, + 4n-1] in advanc e using a tran sfer instruction: For example, store rising po int data and falling[...]
-
Page 407
405 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.4 FNC 63 – INCD / Incremental Drum Seque ncer 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 408
406 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.4 FNC 63 – INCD / Incremental Drum Seque ncer Operation 1) Timing chart Suppose that the follow ing data is written in adva nce by a transfer instruction: 2) When the command contact turn s ON, [...]
-
Page 409
407 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.5 FNC 64 – TTMR / Teaching Timer 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX [...]
-
Page 410
408 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.5 FNC 64 – TTMR / Teaching Timer Cautions 1. When the command co ntact turns OFF The current value [ +1] of the pres sing and holdin g time is reset, and the teac hing time will not change any m[...]
-
Page 411
409 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.6 FNC 65 – STMR / Special Timer 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 412
410 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.6 FNC 65 – STMR / Special Timer Flicker In the program shown belo w which turns OFF STMR in struction at the NC contac t of +3, flicker is output to +1 and +2. and +3 are occup ied. • M0 [ ] :[...]
-
Page 413
411 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.7 FNC 66 – ALT / Alternate Stat e 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX[...]
-
Page 414
412 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.7 FNC 66 – ALT / Alternate Stat e Caution 1. When using (continuous operation type) ALT instruction • When ALT instructi on is used, a spec ified bit device is a lternated in every operation c[...]
-
Page 415
413 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.8 FNC 67 – RAMP / Ramp Variable Value 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Externa[...]
-
Page 416
414 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.8 FNC 67 – RAMP / Ramp Variable Value • After transfer is co mpleted, the instructio n executi on complete fl ag M8029 tur ns ON, and th e value i s returned to the value. • When acquiring t[...]
-
Page 417
415 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.9 FNC 68 – ROTC / Rotary Table Control 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 418
416 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.9 FNC 68 – ROTC / Rotary Table Control Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit o peration (RO TC) The table rotation is controlled by "m2", and so that a product can be efficie[...]
-
Page 419
417 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.9 FNC 68 – ROTC / Rotary Table Control 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 420
418 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.10 FNC 69 – SORT / SORT Tabu lated Data 14.10 FNC 69 – SORT / SORT Tabulated D ata Outline This instruction sorts a data tab le consisting of data (lines) and gro up data (columns) based on a [...]
-
Page 421
419 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.10 FNC 69 – SORT / SORT Tabu lated Data 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 422
420 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 14 Handy Instruction – FNC 60 to FN C 69 14.10 FNC 69 – SORT / SORT Tabu lated Data 2) Sorting result when th e instruction is executed w ith "n = K3 (column No. 3)" Related device → For the instruc tion execution com plete fl[...]
-
Page 423
421 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 Externa[...]
-
Page 424
422 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.1 FNC 70 – TKY / Ten Key Input 15.1 FNC 70 – TKY / Ten Key Input Outline This instruction sets data for timers and counters through ten key in puts ranging from "0" to "9&q[...]
-
Page 425
423 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.1 FNC 70 – TKY / Ten Key Input 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 426
424 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.1 FNC 70 – TKY / Ten Key Input 3. Number of o ccupied de vice 1) Ten bit devices are occupi ed from for conne cting the ten keys. Because these devices are occupied even if the te n keys ar[...]
-
Page 427
425 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.2 FNC 71 – HKY / Hexadecimal Input 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 428
426 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.2 FNC 71 – HKY / Hexadecimal Input 1) Input of a numeric value through keys 0 to 9: - When an input value is large r than "9999", it overflows fro m the most significant di git. -[...]
-
Page 429
427 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.2 FNC 71 – HKY / Hexadecimal Input 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 430
428 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.2 FNC 71 – HKY / Hexadecimal Input Program example The figure belo w shows an exampl e of the FX 3U series main unit (sink input/sink output). For wiring details, refer to the following man[...]
-
Page 431
429 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.3 FNC 72 – DSW / Digital Switch (Thumb wheel Input) 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 [...]
-
Page 432
430 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.3 FNC 72 – DSW / Digital Switch (Thumb wheel Input) 2) Specification of the number of sets ("n") - When us ing one set of 4 digi ts [n = k1] A 4-digi t BCD digital switch conn ect[...]
-
Page 433
431 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.3 FNC 72 – DSW / Digital Switch (Thumb wheel Input) 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 [...]
-
Page 434
432 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.4 FNC 73 – SEGD / Seven Segment Decoder 15.4 FNC 73 – SEGD / Seven Segment Decoder Outline This instruction deco des data, a nd turns th e seven-seg ment display unit (1 digit) ON. 1. Ins[...]
-
Page 435
433 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.4 FNC 73 – SEGD / Seven Segment Decoder 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 436
434 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Seven Segment Wit h Latch 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Se ven Segment With Latch Outline This instruction controls one or two sets of 4-d igit seven-segment display units having[...]
-
Page 437
435 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Seven Segment Wit h Latch 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FN[...]
-
Page 438
436 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Seven Segment Wit h Latch Cautions 1. Time to update the 4-digit se ven-segment display The scan time (operation cycle) multiplied by 12 is re quir ed to upd ate (one or t[...]
-
Page 439
437 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Seven Segment Wit h Latch 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FN[...]
-
Page 440
438 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.5 FNC 74 – SEGL / Seven Segment Wit h Latch 3. Confirming the logic of the sev en-segment display unit 1) Data inpu t 2) Strobe signal 4. Setting the para meter "n" Set a proper v[...]
-
Page 441
439 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.6 FNC 75 – ARWS / Arrow Switch 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 442
440 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.6 FNC 75 – ARWS / Arrow Switch Contents of the displ ay and operat ion part 1) Specif ying the numb er of digits of the seve n-segment di splay unit h aving the BCD decoder n In the explana[...]
-
Page 443
441 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.6 FNC 75 – ARWS / Arrow Switch 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External [...]
-
Page 444
442 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.6 FNC 75 – ARWS / Arrow Switch Program M8000 T0 D300 T1 D301 T99 D399 Practical timer circuit X000 M0 Decrement X001 M1 Increment X002 M2 Higher digit RUN mon itor M3 Lower digit X004 FNC 6[...]
-
Page 445
443 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.7 FNC 76 – ASC / ASCII Code Data Input 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 E[...]
-
Page 446
444 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.7 FNC 76 – ASC / ASCII Code Data Input Extension function When M8161 is set to ON for making the exte nsion function valid, a half-wi dth alphanumeric char acter string specified in is conv[...]
-
Page 447
445 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.8 FNC 77 – PR / Print (AS CII Code) 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 448
446 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.8 FNC 77 – PR / Print (AS CII Code) Extension function 1. 16-byte serial outpu t The number of output charac ters varies depend ing on the ON/OFF status of the special auxiliary relay M8027[...]
-
Page 449
447 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.8 FNC 77 – PR / Print (AS CII Code) 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 450
448 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Speci al Function Block 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read Fr om A Special Function Block Outline This instru ction reads the contents of buffer memorie s (BMF) in a [...]
-
Page 451
449 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Speci al Function Block 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 1[...]
-
Page 452
450 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Speci al Function Block Program examples In programs, the conten ts of buffer me mories (BFMs) in sp ecial extens ion unit s/blocks are read (trans ferred) to [...]
-
Page 453
451 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Speci al Function Block 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 1[...]
-
Page 454
452 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.9 FNC 78 – FROM / Read From A Speci al Function Block Acceptance of interrupts while FROM/TO instruction is executed (M8028) 1. While M8028 is OFF While a FROM/TO instructio n is being exec[...]
-
Page 455
453 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.10 FNC 79 – TO / Write To A Sp ecial Functio n Block 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15[...]
-
Page 456
454 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 15 External FX I/O D evice – FNC 70 to FNC 79 15.10 FNC 79 – TO / Write To A Sp ecial Functio n Block 2. 32-bit operation (DTO an d DTOP) PLC (word de vice) → Special extension unit/block (BFM) "n"-point 32-bit data starti ng [...]
-
Page 457
455 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 External FX [...]
-
Page 458
456 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.1 FNC 80 – RS / Seri al Communication 16.1 FNC 80 – RS / Serial Commun ication Outline This instructio n sends and rec eives data u sing non-protoc ol communication by way of a seri al port (o[...]
-
Page 459
457 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.1 FNC 80 – RS / Seri al Communication 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Externa[...]
-
Page 460
458 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.2 FNC 81 – PRUN / P ara llel Run (Octal Mode) 16.2 FNC 81 – PRUN / Para llel Run (Octal Mode) Outline This instr uction handles the de vice number of with di git specification and th e device [...]
-
Page 461
459 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.2 FNC 81 – PRUN / P ara llel Run (Octal Mode) 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 462
460 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.3 FNC 82 – ASCI / Hexadecimal to ASCII Conversion 16.3 FNC 82 – ASCI / Hexade cimal to ASCII Conversion Outline This instruction converts hexadecimal code in to ASCII code. On the other hand, [...]
-
Page 463
461 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.3 FNC 82 – ASCI / Hexadecimal to ASCII Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 464
462 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.3 FNC 82 – ASCI / Hexadecimal to ASCII Conversion 3. 8-bit convers ion mode (while M 8161 is ON) (M8161 is used also for the RS , HEX, CCD and CRC instructions.) Each digit o f hexadecimal d ata[...]
-
Page 465
463 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.4 FNC 83 – HEX / ASCII to Hexadecimal Conversi on 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 466
464 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.4 FNC 83 – HEX / ASCII to Hexadecimal Conversi on 2. 16-bit conversion mode (while M8161 is OFF) (M8161 is used also for the RS , ASCI, CCD, and CRC instructions.) Each ASCII code stored in hig [...]
-
Page 467
465 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.4 FNC 83 – HEX / ASCII to Hexadecimal Conversi on 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 468
466 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.5 FNC 84 – CCD / Check Code 16.5 FNC 84 – CCD / Check Code Outline This instruction calcula tes the horizontal parity valu e and sum check va lue in the error check methods used in communicati[...]
-
Page 469
467 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.5 FNC 84 – CCD / Check Code 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O D[...]
-
Page 470
468 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.5 FNC 84 – CCD / Check Code 3. 8-bit convers ion mode (while M 8161 is ON) (M8161 is used also for the RS , ASCI, HEX and CRC instructions.) With regard to "n" data starting from , the[...]
-
Page 471
469 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.6 FNC 85 - VRRD / Volume Read 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O D[...]
-
Page 472
470 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.6 FNC 85 - VRRD / Volume Read 2. Example in which the analog value s of the variable analog potentio meters Nos. 0 to 7 are read in turn, and used as ana log timers K0 to K7 are specified in of th[...]
-
Page 473
471 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.7 FNC 86 - VRSC / Volume Scale 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O [...]
-
Page 474
472 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.7 FNC 86 - VRSC / Volume Scale Program example 1. Example in which the scale valu e is used as a rotary switch One of the auxiliary re lays from M0 to M10 turn s ON in accordance with the scale va[...]
-
Page 475
473 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.8 FNC 87 – RS2 / Serial Commun ication 2 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 476
474 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.8 FNC 87 – RS2 / Serial Commun ication 2 Related devices → For detailed ex planation, refer to the Data Commun ication Edition. *1. Ch0 is availa ble only in FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs. Ch2 is not ava[...]
-
Page 477
475 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.8 FNC 87 – RS2 / Serial Commun ication 2 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 478
476 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.9 FNC 88 – PID / PID Control Loop 16.9 FNC 88 – PID / PID Control Loop Outline This instru ction exe cutes PID contro l which ch anges the ou tput value according to the input va riation. → [...]
-
Page 479
477 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.9 FNC 88 – PID / PID Control Loop 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX[...]
-
Page 480
478 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.9 FNC 88 – PID / PID Control Loop *1. + 20 to +24 are occupied when any bit 1, 2 or 5 is set to "1" in +1 for operation setting (ACT). +20 *1 Input var iation (incr emental) alarm set [...]
-
Page 481
479 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 16 External FX Device – FNC 80 to FNC 89 16.9 FNC 88 – PID / PID Control Loop 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX[...]
-
Page 482
480 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 17 Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FN C109 17. Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FNC109 FNC100 to F NC109 provid e instructi ons for exe cuting compli cated pr ocessing for fundament al applied instructi ons and for executing sp ecial processin g. [...]
-
Page 483
481 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 17 Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FN C109 17.1 FNC102 – ZPUSH/Batch Store of Index Register 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 484
482 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 17 Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FN C109 17.1 FNC102 – ZPUSH/Batch Store of Index Register 4) The figure below show s the data structure batch -stored in and later. Related instruction Cautions • When not using the nest struct ure, clea r[...]
-
Page 485
483 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 17 Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FN C109 17.1 FNC102 – ZPUSH/Batch Store of Index Register 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 486
484 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 17 Data Transfer 2 – FNC100 to FN C109 17.2 FNC103 – ZPOP/ Batch POP of Inde x Register 17.2 FNC103 – ZPOP/Batch POP of Index Register Outline This instruction re stores the conten ts of the index register s V0 to V7 and Z0 to Z8 which [...]
-
Page 487
485 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 External FX Devi[...]
-
Page 488
486 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 129 INT Fl oating Point to Intege r Conversion Section 18.17 130 SIN Floating Point Si ne Section 18.18 131 COS Floating P oint Cosine Section 18.19 132 TAN Flo ating Point Tang ent Sect ion 18.20 133 AS[...]
-
Page 489
487 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.1 FNC110 – ECMP / Floating Po int Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Externa[...]
-
Page 490
488 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.2 FNC111 – EZCP / Floating Poin t Zone Compare 18.2 FNC111 – EZCP / Floa ting Point Zone Compare Outline This instr uction compares data (binary flo ating point) wit h two values (o ne zone), and [...]
-
Page 491
489 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.2 FNC111 – EZCP / Floating Poin t Zone Compare 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 492
490 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.3 FNC112 – EMOV / Floating Poi nt Move 18.3 FNC112 – EMOV / Floating Point Move Outline This instruction transfers bi nary floa ting point da ta. → For handling of floating point, refer to Subse[...]
-
Page 493
491 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 494
492 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion 2. In the case of decimal point format • The total number of digits which can be specified by +1 is as follows (24 digits maximum):[...]
-
Page 495
493 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 496
494 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion • The number of digi ts of the d ecimal pa rt which ca n be spec ified by +2 is from 0 to 7. However, the following mus t be satisf[...]
-
Page 497
495 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 498
496 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.4 FNC116 – ESTR / Floating Po int to Character String Conversion Program examples 1) In the progra m example show n below, the c ontents (b ina ry floating poin t data) of R0 and R1 are co nverted a[...]
-
Page 499
497 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.5 FNC117 – EVAL / Character String to Float ing Point Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 500
498 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.5 FNC117 – EVAL / Character String to Float ing Point Conversion a) In the case of decimal point format b) In the case of ex ponent forma t • When a character string to be converted in to binary f[...]
-
Page 501
499 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.5 FNC117 – EVAL / Character String to Float ing Point Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 502
500 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.5 FNC117 – EVAL / Character String to Float ing Point Conversion Related devices → For the use methods of the zero , borrow and carry flags, refer to Subs ection 6.5.2. Related instructions Errors[...]
-
Page 503
501 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.5 FNC117 – EVAL / Character String to Float ing Point Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction[...]
-
Page 504
502 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.6 FNC118 – EBCD / Floating Point to Scientific Not ation Conversion 18.6 FNC118 – EBCD / Floa ting Point to Scientific Notation Conversion Outline This instruction c onverts binary floating point [...]
-
Page 505
503 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.7 FNC119 – EBI N / Scientifi c Notation to Fl oating Point Con version 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instr[...]
-
Page 506
504 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.7 FNC119 – EBI N / Scientifi c Notation to Fl oating Point Con version Program example By DEBIN ins truction, a n umeric valu e containi ng the decimal point can b e directly co nverted int o binary[...]
-
Page 507
505 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.8 FNC120 – EADD / Floating Point Ad dition 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Extern[...]
-
Page 508
506 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.9 FNC121 – ESUB / Floating Po int Subtraction 18.9 FNC121 – ESUB / Floa ting Point Subtraction Outline This instruction executes subtraction of two binary floatin g point data. → For program exa[...]
-
Page 509
507 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.10 FNC122 – EMUL / Floating Point Mult iplication 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 510
508 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.11 FNC123 – EDIV / Floating Point Divi sion 18.11 FNC123 – EDIV / Fl oating Point Division Outline This instruction e xecutes div ision of two binary floa ting poin t. → For program examp les of[...]
-
Page 511
509 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.12 FNC124 – EXP / Fl oating Point Expo nent 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 512
510 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.12 FNC124 – EXP / Fl oating Point Expo nent Program example In the pr ogram exampl e shown below , the expone ntial opera tion is exec uted for a val ue set in th e 2-digit BC D format in X020 to X0[...]
-
Page 513
511 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.13 FNC125 – LOGE / Floating Point Natu ral Logarithm 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FN[...]
-
Page 514
512 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.13 FNC125 – LOGE / Floating Point Natu ral Logarithm Program example In the prog ram example s hown below, natural log arithm of "10" se t in D50 is c alculated , and stored to D30 and D31[...]
-
Page 515
513 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.14 FNC126 – LOG10 / Floating Point Common Log arithm 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FN[...]
-
Page 516
514 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.14 FNC126 – LOG10 / Floating Point Common Log arithm Program example In the progra m example sho wn below, commo n logarithm of "15" set in D50 is calcul ated, and s tored to D30 an d D31 [...]
-
Page 517
515 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.15 FNC127 – ESQR / Floating Poi nt Square Root 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 518
516 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.16 FNC128 – ENEG / Floating Point Negation 18.16 FNC128 – ENEG / Fl oating Point Negation Outline This instru ction inverts the sign of binary flo ating point (re al number) d ata. → For handlin[...]
-
Page 519
517 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.17 FNC129 – INT / Floating Poi nt to Integer Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70[...]
-
Page 520
518 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.17 FNC129 – INT / Floating Poi nt to Integer Conversion Related devices → For the me thods of zero, borrow and carr y flags, re fer to Subsec tion 6.5.2. Caution 1. Caution in the operation • Va[...]
-
Page 521
519 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.18 FNC130 – SIN / Floating Point Sine 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX[...]
-
Page 522
520 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.19 FNC131 – COS / Floating Point Cosi ne 18.19 FNC131 – COS / Fl oating Point Cosine Outline This instruction obtains the cos ine value of an angle (in radians). → For handling of floating point[...]
-
Page 523
521 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.20 FNC132 – TAN / Floating Point Tan gent 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Externa[...]
-
Page 524
522 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.21 FNC133 – ASIN / Float ing Point Arc Sine 18.21 FNC133 – ASIN / Fl oating Point Arc Sine Outline This instruction e xecutes SIN − 1 (arc sine) op eration. → For handling of floating point, r[...]
-
Page 525
523 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.21 FNC133 – ASIN / Float ing Point Arc Sine 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 526
524 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.22 FNC134 – ACOS / Floating Poin t Arc Cosine 18.22 FNC134 – ACOS / Floa ting Point Arc Cosine Outline This instruction e xecutes COS − 1 (arc cosine) operation. → For handling of floating poi[...]
-
Page 527
525 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.22 FNC134 – ACOS / Floating Poin t Arc Cosine 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ext[...]
-
Page 528
526 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.23 FNC135 – ATAN / Floating Point Arc Tan gent 18.23 FNC135 – ATAN / Floa ting Point Arc Tangent Outline This instruction e xecutes the TA N − 1 (arc tangent) operation. → For handling of floa[...]
-
Page 529
527 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.23 FNC135 – ATAN / Floating Point Arc Tan gent 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 530
528 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.24 FNC136 – RAD / Floating Point Degrees to Radians Conversion 18.24 FNC136 – RAD / Floati ng Poi nt Degrees to Radians Conversion Outline This ins truction co nverts a val ue in de grees into a v[...]
-
Page 531
529 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.24 FNC136 – RAD / Floating Point Degrees to Radians Conversion 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 1[...]
-
Page 532
530 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 18 Floating Point – FNC110 to FNC139 18.25 FNC137 – DEG / Floating Point Radians to Degrees Conversion 18.25 FNC137 – DEG / Floating Poi nt Radians to Degr ees Conversion Outline This instruction c onverts a va lue in radi ans into a va[...]
-
Page 533
531 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 External FX [...]
-
Page 534
532 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.1 FNC140 – WSUM / Sum of Word Data 19.1 FNC140 – WSUM / Sum of W ord Data Outline This instruc tion calculat es the sum of consecut ive 16-bit or 32-bit da ta. When calculatin g the addition d[...]
-
Page 535
533 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.1 FNC140 – WSUM / Sum of Word Data 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External F[...]
-
Page 536
534 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.2 FNC141 – WTOB / WORD to BYTE 19.2 FNC141 – WTOB / WORD to BYTE Outline This instruction separates consecutive 16-b it data in byte units (8 bits). 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applic[...]
-
Page 537
535 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.2 FNC141 – WTOB / WORD to BYTE 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/[...]
-
Page 538
536 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.3 FNC142 – BTOW / BYTE to WORD 19.3 FNC142 – BTOW / BYTE to WORD Outline This instruction combine s the low-order 8 bits (low-orde r byte) of consecutive 16-b it data. 1. Instruction format 2.[...]
-
Page 539
537 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.3 FNC142 – BTOW / BYTE to WORD 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/[...]
-
Page 540
538 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.4 FNC143 – UNI / 4-bit Lin king of Word Data 19.4 FNC143 – UNI / 4-bi t Linking of Word Data Outline This instruc tion combines the low-order 4 bits of con secutive 16-b it data. 1. Instructio[...]
-
Page 541
539 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.4 FNC143 – UNI / 4-bit Lin king of Word Data 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 542
540 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.5 FNC144 – DIS / 4-bit Groupin g of Word Data 19.5 FNC144 – DIS / 4-bit Grouping of Word Data Outline This instruction separates 16 -bit data into 4 bit units. 1. Instruction format 2. Set dat[...]
-
Page 543
541 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.5 FNC144 – DIS / 4-bit Groupin g of Word Data 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79[...]
-
Page 544
542 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.6 FNC147 – SWAP / Byte Swap 19.6 FNC147 – SW AP / Byte Swap Outline This instruction swaps the high-ord er 8 bits and low-order 8 bits of a word devi ce. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. A[...]
-
Page 545
543 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.7 FNC149 – SORT2 / Sor t Tabulate d Data 2 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 546
544 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.7 FNC149 – SORT2 / Sor t Tabulate d Data 2 The data tabl e configur ation is expla ined in an exampl e in which the sort ing source data table ha s 3 lines and 4 columns (m1 = K3, m2 = K4). Fo r[...]
-
Page 547
545 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.7 FNC149 – SORT2 / Sor t Tabulate d Data 2 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Ex[...]
-
Page 548
546 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 19 Data Ope ration 2 – FNC140 to FNC1 49 19.7 FNC149 – SORT2 / Sor t Tabulate d Data 2 Related devices → For the instruc tion execution com plete flag use meth od, refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. Related instruction Cautions • Do not chan[...]
-
Page 549
547 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I/O Device 16 FNC80-FNC89 External [...]
-
Page 550
548 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.1 FNC150 – DSZR / Dog Search Zero Return 20.1 FNC150 – DSZR / D og Search Zero Return Outline This instructio n executes a zero re turn, and aligns the mechanical po sition with a p resent [...]
-
Page 551
549 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.1 FNC150 – DSZR / Dog Search Zero Return 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 E[...]
-
Page 552
550 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.2 FNC151 – DVIT / Inte rrupt Positioni ng 20.2 FNC151 – DVIT / Interrupt Positioning Outline This instruction e xecutes one -speed interrupt constant qu antity feed . → For explan ation o[...]
-
Page 553
551 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.2 FNC151 – DVIT / Inte rrupt Positioni ng 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 [...]
-
Page 554
552 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.3 FNC152 – TBL / Batch Data Posi tioning Mode 20.3 FNC152 – TBL / B atch Data Positioning Mode Outline This instru ction execut es one specifie d table oper ation from the data table set in[...]
-
Page 555
553 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.4 FNC155 – ABS / Absolute Current Valu e Read 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FN[...]
-
Page 556
554 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.5 FNC156 – ZRN / Zero Return 20.5 FNC156 – ZRN / Z ero Return Outline This instructio n executes a zero re turn, and aligns the mechanical po sition with a p resent value regis ter inside t[...]
-
Page 557
555 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.5 FNC156 – ZRN / Zero Return 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 External FX I[...]
-
Page 558
556 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.6 FNC157 – PLSV / Variabl e Speed Pulse Output 20.6 FNC157 – PLSV / Variable Speed Pulse Output Outline This instruction outputs variable sp eed pulses with an ass igned rotation direction.[...]
-
Page 559
557 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.6 FNC157 – PLSV / Variabl e Speed Pulse Output 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-F[...]
-
Page 560
558 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.7 FNC158 – DRVI / Drive to Increment 20.7 FNC158 – DRVI / Drive to Increment Outline This instruction execute s one-speed positi oning by incr e mental drive. T he movement distance from th[...]
-
Page 561
559 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.7 FNC158 – DRVI / Drive to Increment 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exter[...]
-
Page 562
560 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.8 FNC159 – DRVA / Dri ve to Absol ute 20.8 FNC159 – DRVA / Drive to Absolute Outline This instruction exe cutes one-speed positioning by abso lute drive. The mov ement distance from th e ze[...]
-
Page 563
561 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 20 Positionin g Control – FNC15 0 to FNC159 20.8 FNC159 – DRVA / Dri ve to Absol ute 11 FNC30-FNC39 Rotation and Shift 12 FNC40-FNC49 Data Operation 13 FNC50-FNC59 High-Speed Processing 14 FMC60-FNC69 Handy Instruction 15 FNC70-FNC79 Exte[...]
-
Page 564
562 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21. Real Time Clock Control – FNC160 to FNC169 FNC160 to F NC169 provi de operatio n and comp arison instru ctions for the time da ta. These instructions ca n set the time of the built-in P [...]
-
Page 565
563 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.1 FNC160 – TCMP / RTC Data Compare 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 [...]
-
Page 566
564 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.1 FNC160 – TCMP / RTC Data Compare Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit o peration (T CMP) The comparison time (hour, minute , and second) stored in , , and is compared with th[...]
-
Page 567
565 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.2 FNC161 – TZCP / RTC Data Zone Compare 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC[...]
-
Page 568
566 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.2 FNC161 – TZCP / RTC Data Zone Compare Cautions 1. Number of o ccupied de vices Three devices are occupied respecti vely by , , , and . Make sure that these devices are no t used in othe[...]
-
Page 569
567 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.3 FNC162 – TADD / RTC Data Additi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 9[...]
-
Page 570
568 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.3 FNC162 – TADD / RTC Data Additi on Cautions 1. Number of o ccupied de vices Three devices are occupied by , and respectively. Make sure that these devices are no t used in other control[...]
-
Page 571
569 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.4 FNC163 – TSUB / RTC Data Subtracti on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC[...]
-
Page 572
570 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.4 FNC163 – TSUB / RTC Data Subtracti on Cautions 1. Number of o ccupied de vices Three devices are occupied by , and respectively. Make sure that these devices are no t used in other cont[...]
-
Page 573
571 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.5 FNC164 – HTOS / Hour to Second Conversion 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190[...]
-
Page 574
572 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.5 FNC164 – HTOS / Hour to Second Conversion 2. 32-bit o peration (DHTOS and DHTOSP) The time data (h our, minute, and sec ond) stored in , +1, and +2 is converted in to data in un its of [...]
-
Page 575
573 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.6 FNC165 – STOH / Second to Hour Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC19[...]
-
Page 576
574 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.6 FNC165 – STOH / Second to Hour Conversi on 2. 32-bit operation (DSTOH and DSTOHP) The time data in units of "second" sto red in + 1 and is converted into data in units of &quo[...]
-
Page 577
575 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.7 FNC166 – TRD / Read RTC data 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Bloc[...]
-
Page 578
576 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.8 FNC167 – TWR / Set RTC data 21.8 FNC167 – TWR / Set RTC data Outline This instructio n writes the cloc k data to the buil t-in PLC real time cl ock. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data [...]
-
Page 579
577 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.8 FNC167 – TWR / Set RTC data 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block[...]
-
Page 580
578 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.9 FNC169 – HOUR / Hour Meter 21.9 FNC169 – HOUR / Hour Meter Outline This instruction measures the ON time of the input contact i n units of hour. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. A[...]
-
Page 581
579 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 21 Real Time Cl ock Control – FNC1 60 to FNC169 21.9 FNC169 – HOUR / Hour Meter 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block [...]
-
Page 582
580 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 22 External De vice – FNC170 to FNC179 22. External Device – FNC170 to FNC179 FNC170 to FNC17 9 provide conve rsion instru ctions for gr ay codes used in abs olute type rota ry encoders and instructions dedi cated to analog blo cks. FNC N[...]
-
Page 583
581 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 22 External De vice – FNC170 to FNC179 22.1 FNC170 – G RY / Decimal to G ray Code Conve rsion 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-[...]
-
Page 584
582 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 22 External De vice – FNC170 to FNC179 22.2 FNC171 – GBIN / Gray Code to Decimal Conversion 22.2 FNC171 – GBIN / Gray Co de to Decimal Conversion Outline This instruction converts a gray cod e into a binary value, and trans fers it. 1. [...]
-
Page 585
583 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 22 External De vice – FNC170 to FNC179 22.3 FNC176 – RD3A / Read form Dedicated Analog Block 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-F[...]
-
Page 586
584 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 22 External De vice – FNC170 to FNC179 22.4 FNC177 – WR3A / Write to Dedi cated Analog Block 22.4 FNC177 – WR3A / Write to Dedicated Analog Block Outline This instruction writes a digi tal value to the ana log block FX 0N -3A *1 or FX 2[...]
-
Page 587
585 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 23 Introduction of Altern ate Instructions – FNC180 23.1 Instruction correspondence table 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 9[...]
-
Page 588
586 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24. Others – FNC181 to FNC189 FNC181 to FNC18 9 provide instru ctions for generatin g random numbers, ex ecuting CRC data operations, an d processing data in high-speed counter operati ons. FNC No. Mnemon ic [...]
-
Page 589
587 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.1 FNC182 – COMRD / Read Device Comment Data 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Dat[...]
-
Page 590
588 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.1 FNC182 – COMRD / Read Device Comment Data 2) The final device of is as follows depe nding on the ON/OFF status of M8091. Related device Caution • Specify a device numbe r in device for which a comment [...]
-
Page 591
589 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.2 FNC184 – RND / Random Number Generation 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data [...]
-
Page 592
590 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.3 FNC186 – DUTY / Timing Pulse Generat ion 24.3 FNC186 – DUTY / Ti ming Pulse Generation Outline This instructio n generates th e timing signal whose o ne cycl e corresponds to the specified number of op[...]
-
Page 593
591 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.3 FNC186 – DUTY / Timing Pulse Generat ion 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data[...]
-
Page 594
592 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.4 FNC188 – CRC / Cyclic Redundan cy Check 24.4 FNC188 – CRC / C yclic Redundancy Check Outline This CRC instruction calcu lates the CRC (cyclic redund ancy check) value which is an err or check method us[...]
-
Page 595
593 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.4 FNC188 – CRC / Cyclic Redundan cy Check 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data [...]
-
Page 596
594 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.4 FNC188 – CRC / Cyclic Redundan cy Check 2. Related device *1. Cleared when the PLC mode is changed from RUN to STOP. Caution In this instr uction, “ X 16 + X 15 + X 2 + 1” is used as a po lynomial fo[...]
-
Page 597
595 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.4 FNC188 – CRC / Cyclic Redundan cy Check 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data [...]
-
Page 598
596 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.5 FNC189 – HCMOV / High-Speed Count er Move 24.5 FNC189 – HCMOV / Hi gh-Speed Counter Move Outline This instruction updates the curren t value of a specifie d high-speed coun ter or ring counter. The fun[...]
-
Page 599
597 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.5 FNC189 – HCMOV / High-Speed Count er Move 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Dat[...]
-
Page 600
598 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.5 FNC189 – HCMOV / High-Speed Count er Move 3) If two or more DHCMOV in structions are used i n one inpu t interrup t program, onl y the first instruction (just after the interrupt poin ter) is executed wh[...]
-
Page 601
599 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 24 Others – FNC1 81 to FNC189 24.5 FNC189 – HCMOV / High-Speed Count er Move 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Dat[...]
-
Page 602
600 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25. Block Data Operation – FNC190 to FNC199 FNC190 to FNC 199 provide instructio ns for adding, subtrac ting and comparing bl ock data. FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol Function Reference 190 – – 191[...]
-
Page 603
601 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.1 FNC192 – BK+ / Block Data Addition 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Bl[...]
-
Page 604
602 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.1 FNC192 – BK+ / Block Data Addition 2. 32-bit operation (DBK+ and DBK+P) 1) "2n" 32-bit binary data starting from [ +1, ] are added to "2n" 32-b it binary da ta starting [...]
-
Page 605
603 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.1 FNC192 – BK+ / Block Data Addition 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Bl[...]
-
Page 606
604 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.2 NFC193 – BK– / Block Data Subtracti on 25.2 NFC193 – BK– / Bloc k Data Subtraction Outline This instruction subtracts bin ary block data. 1. Instruction format 2. Set data 3. Applicab[...]
-
Page 607
605 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.2 NFC193 – BK– / Block Data Subtracti on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1[...]
-
Page 608
606 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.2 NFC193 – BK– / Block Data Subtracti on Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067 turns ON, and the error code is stored in D8067. • When "n[...]
-
Page 609
607 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.3 FNC194~199 – BKCMP=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Block Data Comp are 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions [...]
-
Page 610
608 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.3 FNC194~199 – BKCMP=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Block Data Comp are Explanation of function and operation 1. 16-bit operation (BKCMP=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / BK CM[...]
-
Page 611
609 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.3 FNC194~199 – BKCMP=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Block Data Comp are 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions [...]
-
Page 612
610 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 25 Block Data Operation – FNC190 to F NC199 25.3 FNC194~199 – BKCMP=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Block Data Comp are Caution • When using 32-b it counters (including 32 -bit high-speed cou nters) For comparing 32-bit counters[...]
-
Page 613
611 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data Operation 26 FNC200-F NC209 Ch[...]
-
Page 614
612 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.1 FNC200 – STR / BIN to Character String Conversi on 26.1 FNC200 – STR / B IN to Character String Conversion Outline This instruction converts bina ry data into character strings (ASCII [...]
-
Page 615
613 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.1 FNC200 – STR / BIN to Character String Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 616
614 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.1 FNC200 – STR / BIN to Character String Conversi on - When the number of all digits stor ed in excluding the sign an d decimal point is larger than the number of digi ts of 16-bit bin ary[...]
-
Page 617
615 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.1 FNC200 – STR / BIN to Character String Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 618
616 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.1 FNC200 – STR / BIN to Character String Conversi on Program example In the pr ogram below, t he 16-bit bi nary data stor ed in D10 is converted into a chara cter string in accordance with[...]
-
Page 619
617 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.2 FNC201 – VAL / Character String to BIN Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 620
618 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.2 FNC201 – VAL / Character String to BIN Conversi on For example, whe n a character stri ng "-123.45" is s pecified in and later, the c onversion resu lt is stored in and as show[...]
-
Page 621
619 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.2 FNC201 – VAL / Character String to BIN Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 622
620 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.2 FNC201 – VAL / Character String to BIN Conversi on 5) [ + 1, ] stores 16-bit data (bin ) converted from a character string with the decimal point ig nored. For the characte r string loca[...]
-
Page 623
621 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.2 FNC201 – VAL / Character String to BIN Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 624
622 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.3 FNC202 – $+ / Link Character Strings 26.3 FNC202 – $+ / Link C haracter Strings Outline This instru ction link s a characte r string to another ch aracter string . → For handling of [...]
-
Page 625
623 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.3 FNC202 – $+ / Link Character Strings 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 [...]
-
Page 626
624 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.4 FNC203 – L EN / Character String Length Detecti on 26.4 FNC203 – LEN / Characte r String Length Detection Outline This instruction detects the number of charac ters (bytes) of a specif[...]
-
Page 627
625 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.4 FNC203 – L EN / Character String Length Detecti on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 2[...]
-
Page 628
626 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.5 FNC204 – RIGHT / Extracting Character String Data from the Right 26.5 FNC204 – RIGHT / Extract ing Char acter String Data from the Right Outline This instru ction extra cts a specifi e[...]
-
Page 629
627 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.5 FNC204 – RIGHT / Extracting Character String Data from the Right 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-F[...]
-
Page 630
628 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.6 FNC205 – LEFT / Extracting Character String Data from the L eft 26.6 FNC205 – LEFT / Extr acting Character String Data from the Left Outline This instruction extracts a specif ied numb[...]
-
Page 631
629 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.6 FNC205 – LEFT / Extracting Character String Data from the L eft 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FN[...]
-
Page 632
630 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.7 FNC206 – MIDR / Ran dom Selection of Character Strin gs 26.7 FNC206 – MIDR / Random Selection of Character Strings Outline This instruction extracts a specifie d number of characters f[...]
-
Page 633
631 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.7 FNC206 – MIDR / Ran dom Selection of Character Strin gs 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Oth[...]
-
Page 634
632 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.7 FNC206 – MIDR / Ran dom Selection of Character Strin gs Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067 turns ON, and the error code is stored in D8067[...]
-
Page 635
633 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.8 FNC207 – MIDW / Random Replacement of Character Strings 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Oth[...]
-
Page 636
634 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.8 FNC207 – MIDW / Random Replacement of Character Strings • The character string stored in and la ter or and later indic ates data stored in d evices from the specified device un til “[...]
-
Page 637
635 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.8 FNC207 – MIDW / Random Replacement of Character Strings 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Oth[...]
-
Page 638
636 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.9 FNC208 – I NSTR / Character st ring search 26.9 FNC208 – INSTR / Ch aracter string search Outline This instru ction search es a specifie d charac ter string within another characte r s[...]
-
Page 639
637 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.9 FNC208 – I NSTR / Character st ring search 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190[...]
-
Page 640
638 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.10 FNC209 – $MOV / Character St ring Transfer 26.10 FNC209 – $MOV / Character String Transfer Outline This instruction transfers character strin g data. → For handling of character str[...]
-
Page 641
639 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 26 Character String Control – FNC200 to FNC209 26.10 FNC209 – $MOV / Character St ring Transfer 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC19[...]
-
Page 642
640 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27. Data Operation 3 – FNC210 to FNC219 FNC210 to FNC2 19 provide in structions for re ading last-in data and controlling le ftward/rightwa rd shift ins tructions with carry. FNC No. Mnemonic Symbo[...]
-
Page 643
641 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.1 FNC210 – FDEL / Deleting Data fro m Tables 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 [...]
-
Page 644
642 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.1 FNC210 – FDEL / Deleting Data fro m Tables Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067 turns ON, and the error code is stored in D8067. • When the tabl[...]
-
Page 645
643 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.2 FNC211 – FINS / Inserting Data to Tables 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99[...]
-
Page 646
644 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.2 FNC211 – FINS / Inserting Data to Tables Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067 turns ON, and the error code is stored in D8067. • When the table [...]
-
Page 647
645 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.3 FNC212 – PO P / Shift Last Data Re ad [FILO Contr ol] 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 F[...]
-
Page 648
646 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.3 FNC212 – PO P / Shift Last Data Re ad [FILO Contr ol] • Subtract “1” from the va lue of the poi nter data . Related device → For the zero flag use method , refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. [...]
-
Page 649
647 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.3 FNC212 – PO P / Shift Last Data Re ad [FILO Contr ol] 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 F[...]
-
Page 650
648 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.4 FNC213 – SFR / Bit Shift Right with Carry 27.4 FNC213 – SFR / Bi t Shift Right with Carry Outline This instructio n shifts 16 bit s stored in a word device righ tward by “n” bi ts. 1. In[...]
-
Page 651
649 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.4 FNC213 – SFR / Bit Shift Right with Carry 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 9[...]
-
Page 652
650 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.5 FNC214 – SFL / Bit Shift Left with Carry 27.5 FNC214 – SFL / B i t Shift Left with Carry Outline This instructio n shifts 16 bit s stored in a word device le ftward by “n” bits. 1. Instr[...]
-
Page 653
651 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 27 Data Ope ration 3 – FNC210 to FNC2 19 27.5 FNC214 – SFL / Bit Shift Left with Carry 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99[...]
-
Page 654
652 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28. Data Comparison – FNC220 to FNC249 FNC220 to FNC2 49 provide data comparison i nstructions wh ich can be handle d as contact symbols in progr amming such as LD, AND and OR. FNC No. Mnemonic Symbo[...]
-
Page 655
653 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block Data Operation 26 FNC200-F NC209 Char acte [...]
-
Page 656
654 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.1 FNC224~230 – LD =, >, <, <>, <=, >= / Data Comparison 28.1 FNC224~230 – LD =, >, <, <>, <=, >= / Data Comparison Outline These instructio ns compare numeric[...]
-
Page 657
655 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.1 FNC224~230 – LD =, >, <, <>, <=, >= / Data Comparison 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FN[...]
-
Page 658
656 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.2 FNC232~238 – AND=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Comparison 28.2 FNC232~238 – AND=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Comparison Outline These instructions co mpare numer[...]
-
Page 659
657 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.2 FNC232~238 – AND=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Comparison 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-F[...]
-
Page 660
658 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.3 FNC240~2 46 – OR=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Co mparison 28.3 FNC240~246 – OR=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Comparison Outline These instructions co mpare numer[...]
-
Page 661
659 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 28 Data Compa rison – FNC220 to FNC249 28.3 FNC240~2 46 – OR=, >, <, < >, <=, >= / Data Co mparison 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-[...]
-
Page 662
660 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29. Data Table Operation – FNC250 to FNC269 FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol Function Reference 250 − − 251 − − 252 − − 253 − − 254 − − 255 − − 256 LIMIT Limit Control S ection 2[...]
-
Page 663
661 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.1 FNC256 – LIMIT / Li mit Control 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Bloc[...]
-
Page 664
662 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.1 FNC256 – LIMIT / Li mit Control • When controlling the output value using only the lower limit value , set “32767” to the upper limit value spec ified in . 2. 32-bit operation (DLIMI[...]
-
Page 665
663 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.1 FNC256 – LIMIT / Li mit Control 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Bloc[...]
-
Page 666
664 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.2 FNC257 – BAND / Dead Band Co ntrol 29.2 FNC257 – BAND / Dead Band Control Outline This instruction provides the upper limit value and lower limit va lue of the dead band for an input num[...]
-
Page 667
665 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.2 FNC257 – BAND / Dead Band Co ntrol 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 B[...]
-
Page 668
666 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.2 FNC257 – BAND / Dead Band Co ntrol Program examples 1. Program example 1 In the program examp le shown below, the BCD data set in X020 to X037 is controlled by th e dead band fro m “-100[...]
-
Page 669
667 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.3 FNC258 – ZONE / Zone Control 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block D[...]
-
Page 670
668 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.3 FNC258 – ZONE / Zone Control 2. 32-bit operation (DZONE and DZONEP) The bias value sp ecified by [ +1, ] or [ +1, ] is added to the input value sp ecified by [ +1, ], and outp ut to the de[...]
-
Page 671
669 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.3 FNC258 – ZONE / Zone Control 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC1 99 Block D[...]
-
Page 672
670 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.4 FNC259 – SCL / Scaling (Coordi nate by Point Data) 29.4 FNC259 – SCL / Scal ing (C oordinate by Point Data) Outline This instruction executes scaling of the input value u sing a specifie[...]
-
Page 673
671 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.4 FNC259 – SCL / Scaling (Coordi nate by Point Data) 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 [...]
-
Page 674
672 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.4 FNC259 – SCL / Scaling (Coordi nate by Point Data) Setting the conversion setti ng data table for scaling Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067[...]
-
Page 675
673 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.4 FNC259 – SCL / Scaling (Coordi nate by Point Data) 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 [...]
-
Page 676
674 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.5 FNC260 – DABIN / Decimal ASCII to BIN Conversi on 29.5 FNC260 – DABIN / Decima l ASCII to BIN Conversion Outline This instruction converts nu meric data expressed in decimal ASCII code s[...]
-
Page 677
675 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.5 FNC260 – DABIN / Decimal ASCII to BIN Conversi on 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 F[...]
-
Page 678
676 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.5 FNC260 – DABIN / Decimal ASCII to BIN Conversi on Program example In the program be low, the sign an d decimal ASCII cod es in fi ve digi ts stored in D20 to D22 are c onverted into a bina[...]
-
Page 679
677 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.6 FNC261 – BINDA / BIN to Decimal ASCII Conversion 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FN[...]
-
Page 680
678 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.6 FNC261 – BINDA / BIN to Decimal ASCII Conversion b) "2 0H (space)" is stor ed for "0" on the left side of the effective di gits (zero suppre ssion). c) +3 is set as fol[...]
-
Page 681
679 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.6 FNC261 – BINDA / BIN to Decimal ASCII Conversion 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FN[...]
-
Page 682
680 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.7 FNC269 – SCL2 / Scaling 2 (Coordina te by X/Y Data) 29.7 FNC269 – SCL2 / Scaling 2 (Coordinate by X/Y Data) Outline This instruction executes scaling of the input value u sing a specifie[...]
-
Page 683
681 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.7 FNC269 – SCL2 / Scaling 2 (Coordina te by X/Y Data) 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25[...]
-
Page 684
682 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.7 FNC269 – SCL2 / Scaling 2 (Coordina te by X/Y Data) Setting the conversion setti ng data table for scaling *1. When coordina tes are specified us ing three points as shown in the p oints 4[...]
-
Page 685
683 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 29 Data Tab le Operatio n – FNC250 to FNC269 29.7 FNC269 – SCL2 / Scaling 2 (Coordina te by X/Y Data) 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25[...]
-
Page 686
684 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30. External Device Communication – FNC270 to FNC276 FNC270 to FNC 276 provide instructio ns for executin g inverter communication and MODBUS communic ation. FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol F[...]
-
Page 687
685 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.1 FNC270 – IVCK / Inverter Status Check 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC[...]
-
Page 688
686 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.1 FNC270 – IVCK / Inverter Status Check 2. Inverter instruction codes The table belo w shows inverter instructio n codes which can be specified in . Only use the instruction codes [...]
-
Page 689
687 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.2 FNC271 – IVDR / Inverter Drive 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC190-FNC[...]
-
Page 690
688 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.2 FNC271 – IVDR / Inverter Drive 2. Inverter instruction codes The table below shows in verter inst ruction code s which can be spe cified in . For instru ction code s, refer to th[...]
-
Page 691
689 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.3 FNC272 – IVRD / In verter Parameter Read 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 [...]
-
Page 692
690 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.3 FNC272 – IVRD / In verter Parameter Read 2. Related devices → For the instruc tion execution com plete flag use meth od, refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. *1. Cleared when PLC power [...]
-
Page 693
691 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.4 FNC273 – IVWR / Inverter Parameter Write 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 [...]
-
Page 694
692 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.4 FNC273 – IVWR / Inverter Parameter Write 2. Related devices → For the instruc tion execution com plete flag use meth od, refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. *1. Cleared when PLC power [...]
-
Page 695
693 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.5 FNC274 – I VBWR / Inverter Para meter Block Write 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 O[...]
-
Page 696
694 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.5 FNC274 – I VBWR / Inverter Para meter Block Write 2. Related devices → For the instruc tion execution com plete flag use meth od, refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. *1. Cleared when P[...]
-
Page 697
695 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.6 FNC275 – IVMC / Inverter Multi Command 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FN[...]
-
Page 698
696 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.6 FNC275 – IVMC / Inverter Multi Command 3. Related devices → For the instruc tion execution com plete flag use meth od, refer to Su bsection 6.5.2. *1. Cleared when PLC power su[...]
-
Page 699
697 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.7 FNC276 - MODBUS Read/Write Instruction 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC1[...]
-
Page 700
698 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.7 FNC276 - MODBUS Read/Write Instruction 30.7.1 Command Code a nd Command Parameters The following table shows the required command parameters for each command code. / 1H Read Coils [...]
-
Page 701
699 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.7 FNC276 - MODBUS Read/Write Instruction 21 FNC160-FNC1 69 Real T i me Clock Control 22 FNC170-FNC179 External Device 23 FNC180 Alternate Instructions 24 FNC181-FNC189 Others 25 FNC1[...]
-
Page 702
700 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 30 External De vice Communi cati on – FNC270 to FNC276 30.7 FNC276 - MODBUS Read/Write Instruction *1. This calculation formula is applicable when the applicable device is D or R. 11H Report Slave ID (Available only in FX 3U and FX 3UC PLCs[...]
-
Page 703
701 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt Functio[...]
-
Page 704
702 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.1 FNC278 – RBFM / Divided BFM Read 31.1 FNC278 – RB FM / Divided BFM Read Outline This instru ction read s data from c ontinuous buffer memori es (BFM) in a special function uni t/block ov er se[...]
-
Page 705
703 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.1 FNC278 – RBFM / Divided BFM Read 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SF[...]
-
Page 706
704 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.1 FNC278 – RBFM / Divided BFM Read Cautions • A watchdog timer error may occur when many numbers of points are transferred in one operation cycle. In such a case, take one of the fo llowing coun[...]
-
Page 707
705 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.1 FNC278 – RBFM / Divided BFM Read 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SF[...]
-
Page 708
706 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.2 FNC279 – WBFM / Divided BFM Writ e 31.2 FNC279 – WBFM / Divided BFM Write Outline This instruction writes da ta to contin uous buffer memories (B FM) in a special function uni t/block over sev[...]
-
Page 709
707 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 31 Data Transfer 3 – FNC277 to FN C279 31.2 FNC279 – WBFM / Divided BFM Writ e 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 [...]
-
Page 710
708 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32. High-Speed Processing 2 – FNC280 to FNC289 FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol Function Reference 280 HSCT High-Speed Counter Compare With D ata Table Section 32. 1 281 − − 282 − − 283 − ?[...]
-
Page 711
709 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32.1 FNC280 – HSCT / High-Speed Counter Compare With Data Ta ble 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control [...]
-
Page 712
710 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32.1 FNC280 – HSCT / High-Speed Counter Compare With Data Ta ble Operation output setting (SET [1] or RESET [0]) [Up to 16 points] 1) When this instruction is executed, the d a ta table is s[...]
-
Page 713
711 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32.1 FNC280 – HSCT / High-Speed Counter Compare With Data Ta ble 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control [...]
-
Page 714
712 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32.1 FNC280 – HSCT / High-Speed Counter Compare With Data Ta ble Cautions • This instruction can be exe cuted onl y once in a program. If this in struction i s programmed two or more time [...]
-
Page 715
713 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 32 High-Speed Proce ssing 2 – FNC280 to FN C289 32.1 FNC280 – HSCT / High-Speed Counter Compare With Data Ta ble 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control [...]
-
Page 716
714 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33. Extension File Register Control – FNC290 to FNC299 FNC No. Mnemonic Symbol Function Reference 290 LOADR Load From ER Se ction 33.1 291 SAVER Save t o ER Sect ion 33.2 292 INITR I[...]
-
Page 717
715 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.1 FNC290 – LOADR / Load From ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 718
716 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.1 FNC290 – LOADR / Load From ER 2) In FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs a) W hen a memory cassette is connec ted (A memory cassette can be connected only to FX 3G PLC.) The contents (c urrent va[...]
-
Page 719
717 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.1 FNC290 – LOADR / Load From ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 720
718 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER Outline This instru ction write s the current values of t he extension registers (R ) stored in th e PLC's bu[...]
-
Page 721
719 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 722
720 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 2. Initia lization o f ex tension file registers Execute th e INITER (FNC295) or INI TR (FNC292) inst ruction to targ et extension fil e registers (E[...]
-
Page 723
721 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 724
722 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER Program examples 1) In the case of FX 3U PLC Ver. 2.20 or later and FX 3UC PLC Ver. 1.30 or later In the example shown below, only extension register[...]
-
Page 725
723 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 726
724 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 2) In the case of FX 3UC PLC before Ver. 1. 30 In the example shown below, only extension register s R10 to R19 (in sector 0) need to be updated in t[...]
-
Page 727
725 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.2 FNC291 – SAVER / Save to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 728
726 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.3 FNC292 – I NITR / Ini tialize R and ER 33.3 FNC292 – INITR / Initialize R and ER Outline This instruc tion initiali zes extension re gisters (R) to “HFFFF” (<K-1>) i[...]
-
Page 729
727 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.3 FNC292 – I NITR / Ini tialize R and ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC[...]
-
Page 730
728 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.3 FNC292 – I NITR / Ini tialize R and ER • Setting the WDT (FNC 07) instruction j ust before and after the INITR ins truction as shown below: If the processing time of the INITR[...]
-
Page 731
729 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.4 FNC293 – LOGR / Logging R and ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 732
730 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.4 FNC293 – LOGR / Logging R and ER Logging data form at The tab le below shows the h ead devi ce number i n each se ctor: Cautions 1. LOGR instruction The LOGR instructio n execut[...]
-
Page 733
731 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.4 FNC293 – LOGR / Logging R and ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 734
732 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.4 FNC293 – LOGR / Logging R and ER 5) To the PLC, write the data which was tempor arily withdr awn to GX Works 2. [1] S elect “Online” → “Write to PLC...” to display the[...]
-
Page 735
733 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.5 FNC294 – RWER / Rewrite to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 736
734 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.5 FNC294 – RWER / Rewrite to ER 2) In FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs a) W hen a memory cassette is connec ted (A memory cassette can be connected only to FX 3G PLC.) The contents (curren t va[...]
-
Page 737
735 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.5 FNC294 – RWER / Rewrite to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 738
736 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.5 FNC294 – RWER / Rewrite to ER 3. Allowable n umber of wri tes to the memory Note the following cautions on acce ss to extensio n file registers. •I n F X 3U /FX 3UC PLCs Data [...]
-
Page 739
737 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.5 FNC294 – RWER / Rewrite to ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 740
738 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.6 FNC295 – INITER / Initiali ze ER 33.6 FNC295 – INITER / Initialize ER Outline This instruc tion initia lizes extensi on file re gisters (ER) to “HFFFF” (<K-1>) in a [...]
-
Page 741
739 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.6 FNC295 – INITER / Initiali ze ER 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 742
740 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 33 Extension File Register Contro l – FNC290 to F NC299 33.6 FNC295 – INITER / Initiali ze ER Errors An operation error is caus ed in the following cases; Th e error flag M8067 turns ON, and the error code is stored in D8067. • When any[...]
-
Page 743
741 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 3[...]
-
Page 744
742 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.1 FNC300 – FL CRT / File create • check 34.1 FNC300 – FLCRT / File create • check Outline The FLCRT instruction creates a file in side the CompactFlash TM card mounted in [...]
-
Page 745
743 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.1 FNC300 – FL CRT / File create • check 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-[...]
-
Page 746
744 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.2 FNC301 – FLDEL / File delet e • CF card format 34.2 FNC301 – FLDE L / File delete • CF card format Outline The FLDEL instru ction deletes file s stored in the CompactFl [...]
-
Page 747
745 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.2 FNC301 – FLDEL / File delet e • CF card format 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 3[...]
-
Page 748
746 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.3 FNC302 – FLWR / Data write 34.3 FNC302 – FLWR / Data write Outline The FLWR instruction w rites data to the Comp actFlash TM card or to the buffer inside the FX 3U -CF-ADP. [...]
-
Page 749
747 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.3 FNC302 – FLWR / Data write 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U [...]
-
Page 750
748 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.3 FNC302 – FLWR / Data write 34.3.1 Detailed explanation of settin g data Details on the setti ng data in the FLWR instructio n are as shown belo w. Cautions • The FLWR instru[...]
-
Page 751
749 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.4 FNC303 – FLRD / Data read 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -[...]
-
Page 752
750 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.4 FNC303 – FLRD / Data read 34.4.1 Detailed explanation of settin g data Details on the setti ng data in the FLRD instruction are as sho wn below. Cautions • The FLRD instruct[...]
-
Page 753
751 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.5 FNC304 – FLCMD / FX3U-CF-ADP command 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC[...]
-
Page 754
752 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.5 FNC304 – FLCMD / FX3U-CF-ADP command 34.5.1 Detailed explanation of settin g data Details on the setti ng data in the FLCMD instruction are as shown below. *1. The CompactF la[...]
-
Page 755
753 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.6 FNC305 – FLSTRD / FX3U-CF-ADP status read 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC30[...]
-
Page 756
754 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.6 FNC305 – FLSTRD / FX3U-CF-ADP status read 34.6.1 Detailed explanation of settin g data Details on the setti ng data in the FLSTR D instruction are a s shown below. • When is[...]
-
Page 757
755 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 34 FX3U-CF-AD P Applied Instruc tions – FNC300 to FNC 305 34.6 FNC305 – FLSTRD / FX3U-CF-ADP status read 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC30[...]
-
Page 758
756 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 35. SFC Program and Step Ladder This chapter ex plains the programming p rocedures a nd sequenc e operations fo r the “SFC ” and “ste p ladder” programming methods in GX Works2 and GX D[...]
-
Page 759
757 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 760
758 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 35.1.3 SFC program creating procedure Create an S FC program using the f ollowing pr ocedure: 1. Operation example 1) When the start pushbutton switch is pressed, the truck moves forw ard. When[...]
-
Page 761
759 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 762
760 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 4. Inputting and indicating a pr ogram using GX Works2 and GX Developer • Input a circuit f or setting the initia l state r elay to ON us ing the re lay ladder. In this example , the initial [...]
-
Page 763
761 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 764
762 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 35.1.6 Role of the RET instruction • Use the RET instructi on at the end of an SF C program. When inputting an SFC program using GX Works2 and GX Developer, ho wever, it is not necess ary to [...]
-
Page 765
763 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 766
764 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program Operation of “ ” and “ V ” Use “ ” to express transfer to a state relay in an upper positi on (repeat), tra nsfer to a st ate relay in a l ower posi tion (jump), or transfe [...]
-
Page 767
765 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 768
766 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program Programming complicated transfer conditions In a tran sfer conditi on circuit , the ANB, ORB, MPS , MRD and MPP instructio ns are not available. Program the circuit as shown below : Processing [...]
-
Page 769
767 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 770
768 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 35.1.8 SFC flow formats This section show s operation pa tterns of single fl ows an d operation pa tterns when selec tive branches and p arallel branches a re combin ed in SFC progr ams. 1. Jum[...]
-
Page 771
769 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 772
770 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program Composite flows with branches and recombination The single flow format is the fundamenta l style in process tra nsfer control. Only sin gle flow is sufficien t in sequence control for s imple o[...]
-
Page 773
771 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 774
772 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 35.1.10 Rule for creating branch circuit Limitation in the number of bra nch circuits In one parallel branch or se lective branch, up to eight circuits can be provided. When there are many para[...]
-
Page 775
773 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 776
774 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 2. When there are selective branches continuously, reduce th e number of branches. X000 20 1 2 X001 21 3 22 4 5 29 X003 X007 6 X004 23 7 24 8 X006 9 10 25 11 26 12 13 X013 X017 X010 X011 14 27 [...]
-
Page 777
775 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 778
776 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 6. It is not permitted to cross flows in SFC programs. Change a flow on the left to a flow on the right. This ch ange enables i nverse conversio n from a program on the instruction word basi s [...]
-
Page 779
777 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 780
778 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 3. Example of cam shaft turnin g control The limit switch es X013 and X01 1 are provided in two positions, large forward ro tation angle an d small forward rotation angle. The limit switch es X[...]
-
Page 781
779 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 782
780 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program The partial skip flo w shown on the previous pa ge can be expressed in a flow of selective branches and recomb ination as shown below. Make sure that a flow proceeds fro m top to bottom, an d t[...]
-
Page 783
781 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 784
782 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program In an SFC pr ogram for selecti ng large o r small produ cts and judging p roducts as eith er accepted or rejected, s elective branches and recombi nation are adopted a s shown in the figure be [...]
-
Page 785
783 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 786
784 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.1 SFC Program M8002 Ladder block SET Initial pu lse 0 SFC block 0 21 1 T0 RET END TRAN 0 X00 0 X00 1 Cro ssing butto n Y003 Road: Green T0 K300 22 2 T1 TRAN Y002 Road: Yellow T1 K100 23 Y001 T2 K50 Road: Red[...]
-
Page 787
785 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 788
786 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder *1. Output coils can be used again i n different state relays. *2. It is not possible to place a po inter immediately after the S TL instruction. If a pointer is placed , a circuit error (Error[...]
-
Page 789
787 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 790
788 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 35.2.4 Creation of step ladder program (SF C program → STL prog ram) The figure on the left sh ows one state relay extracted as an example from an SFC program. Each state relay has three func[...]
-
Page 791
789 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 792
790 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder Special auxiliary re lays For efficie ntly creati ng step ladd er programs, it i s nece ssary to use some spec ial auxiliary relays. The tabl e below shows major ones. The special auxil iary re[...]
-
Page 793
791 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 794
792 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 35.2.6 Program with state relays in branch es and recombination 1. Example of selective branch Do not use MPS, MRD, MPP, ANB and ORB instructi ons in a transfer proce ssing program with bra nch[...]
-
Page 795
793 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 796
794 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 4. Example of parallel recombinatio n Do not use MPS , MRD, MPP, ANB and ORB instruc tions in a pr ogram with bra nches and r ecombination. Even in a load driv ing circuit, MPS instructions ca [...]
-
Page 797
795 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 798
796 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 35.2.7 Program examples Examples of single flows 1. Example of fl icker circuit • When the PLC mode is changed from STOP to RUN, the state relay S3 is driven b y the initi al pulse (M8002) . [...]
-
Page 799
797 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 800
798 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder Examples of flows with selective branches and recombination 1. Example of selecting and carrying la rge and small balls The figure belo w shows a mechanism w hich selects and carrie s large and[...]
-
Page 801
799 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 802
800 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder Example of flows with parallel branches and recombinatio n When the parts A, B and C are proces sed in parallel an d then assembled, flows ha ving parallel branch es and recombination a re used[...]
-
Page 803
801 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 35 SFC Program and St ep Ladder 35.2 Step Ladder 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Programming 36 Interrupt[...]
-
Page 804
802 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.1 Outline 36. Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function This chapter explai ns the built-in interrupt fun ction and pulse catch function in FX PLC. 36.1 Outline This section exp lains the fu[...]
-
Page 805
803 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.2 Comm on Items 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Program[...]
-
Page 806
804 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.2 Comm on Items 2) Program ex ample In the program example show n below, when M8053 is set to ON by M20, the inte rrupt input I301 triggered by X003 is disabl ed. 36.2.2 Related items 1. Using[...]
-
Page 807
805 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.2 Comm on Items 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Program[...]
-
Page 808
806 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.2 Comm on Items Example in which latch ed outputs are reset (counterm easures) 1) Program ex ample 2) Timing chart RST C0 X002 FNC 06 FEND RST C0 RST Y007 Program t o reset Y007 at an arbi tra[...]
-
Page 809
807 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension [...]
-
Page 810
808 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 5. How to disable each interrupt input When any amo ng M8050 to M8 055 is set t o ON in a pr ogram, int[...]
-
Page 811
809 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension [...]
-
Page 812
810 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 4) When catching a short pulse In the program example shown below, the ON stat us is he ld for a certai[...]
-
Page 813
811 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension [...]
-
Page 814
812 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.3 Input Inte rrupt (Interrupt T riggered by Ex ternal Signal) [W ithout Dela y Function] 2. Example of progra m to measure t he short pulse width using a high -speed ring counter (only in FX 3[...]
-
Page 815
813 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.4 Input interrup t (Interrupt by Externa l Signal) [With Delay Fun ction] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register C[...]
-
Page 816
814 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.5 Timer Interrup t (Interrupt in Constant C ycle) 3. Basic program (progra mming procedure) 4. Number and operation of (th ree) timer interrupt point ers An interrupt routine p rogram is execu[...]
-
Page 817
815 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.5 Timer Interrup t (Interrupt in Constant C ycle) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 [...]
-
Page 818
816 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.5 Timer Interrup t (Interrupt in Constant C ycle) 2. Timer interrupt processing of RAMP (FNC 67) instruction The ramp signal output circu it shown below is prog rammed using the timer i nterru[...]
-
Page 819
817 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.5 Timer Interrup t (Interrupt in Constant C ycle) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 [...]
-
Page 820
818 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.6 Counter Interrupt - Inte rrupt Triggered by Counting Up o f High-Spee d Counter 36.6 Counter Interrupt - Interrupt Tri ggered by Counting Up of High-Speed Counter 1. Outline This type of int[...]
-
Page 821
819 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.7 Pulse Catch Fu nction [M8170 to M8177] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF[...]
-
Page 822
820 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.8 Pulse width/Pulse p eriod measuremen t fu nction [M8 075 to M807 9, D8074 to D8 097] 36.8 Pulse width/Pulse period measurem ent function [M8075 to M8079, D8074 to D8097] The puls e width/pul[...]
-
Page 823
821 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.8 Pulse width/Pulse p eriod measuremen t fu nction [M8 075 to M807 9, D8074 to D8 097] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension Fi[...]
-
Page 824
822 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.8 Pulse width/Pulse p eriod measuremen t fu nction [M8 075 to M807 9, D8074 to D8 097] 3) Signal delay time me asurement The delay time from the rising e dge of the inp ut signal from X0 00 to[...]
-
Page 825
823 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 36 Interrupt Function and Pulse Catch Function 36.8 Pulse width/Pulse p eriod measuremen t fu nction [M8 075 to M807 9, D8074 to D8 097] 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension Fi[...]
-
Page 826
824 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37. Operation of Special Devices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Device List (M8000 -, D8000 -) The device numbers a nd function s of the special[...]
-
Page 827
825 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 828
826 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) PLC Mode M 8030 *1 Battery L ED OFF When M8030 set to ON, LED on PLC is not lit even if batter y voltage low i s detected . → Refer to S ubsect[...]
-
Page 829
827 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 830
828 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Error Detectio n (Refer to Chapte r 38 for details.) [M]8060 I/O config uration err or – D8060 – – – [M]8061 PLC h[...]
-
Page 831
829 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 832
830 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Memory Information [M]8101 Not used – – – – – – ––––– [M]8102 – – – – – – ––––– [M]8103 – – – ?[...]
-
Page 833
831 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 834
832 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Advanced Funct ion M 8160 *1 SWAP function of XCH (FNC 17) – – – –– – – M 8161 *1*2 8-bit pro cess mode [...]
-
Page 835
833 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 836
834 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Counter Up/down Cou nter Counting Direct ion (R efer to Sect ion 4.6 for deta ils.) M 8200 C200 When M8 is ON, the correspondi ng C [...]
-
Page 837
835 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 838
836 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Flags [M]8300 to [ M]8303 Not used – – – – – – ––––– [M]8304 Zero ON when th e multiplica tion and divi sion calculated res[...]
-
Page 839
837 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 840
838 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Positioning [FX 3U ] (Re fer to Positioning Control Man ual for details.) [M]8370 [Y003] Pu lse output monito r (ON: BUSY/ OFF: READY) – – ?[...]
-
Page 841
839 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 842
840 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) FX 3U -CF-ADP [ch1] (Refer to CF-A DP Manual for details .) [M]8400 to [ M]8401 Not used – – – – – – ––––– [M]8402 CF-ADP i[...]
-
Page 843
841 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 844
842 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1.2 Special Data Register (D8000 to D8511) Number a nd name Content of register Applicable model FX 3S FX 3G FX 3GC FX 3U FX 3UC Correspond- i[...]
-
Page 845
843 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 846
844 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Input Filter D 8020 Input filter adjustment Input filt er value of X00 0 to X017 *1 (Default: 10 ms) → Refer to S ubsection 37.2.9. [...]
-
Page 847
845 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 848
846 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Parallel Li nk (Ref er to Data Communication Edition for details.) [D]8070 Parall el link erro r time-out ch eck time: 50 0 ms ?[...]
-
Page 849
847 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 850
848 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Memory Information [D]8101 PLC type and system versio n 28 26 26 16 1 6 – ––––– [D]8102 Memory capacity 2 ...... 2K steps 4 ...... 4K[...]
-
Page 851
849 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 852
850 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Inverter Communication Func tion (Refer to Data Commun ication Edition fo r details.) D 8150 *1 Response wait time o f inverter commun ication [c[...]
-
Page 853
851 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 854
852 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Index Register Z1 to Z7 and V1 to V7 [D]8182 Value of Z1 registe r – [D]8183 Value of V1 registe r [...]
-
Page 855
853 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 856
854 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Display Module Function (F X 3G -5DM, FX 3U -7DM) (Refer to Ha rdware Editio n Manual of PLC main unit use d for details.) D 8300 Control devi ce[...]
-
Page 857
855 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 858
856 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) Positi oning [ FX 3G /FX 3U /FX 3UC ] (Refer to Positioning Control Edition for details.) D 8360 Lower [Y002] Curre nt value regi ster Default: 0[...]
-
Page 859
857 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 860
858 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) RS2 (FNC 87) [ch2] an d Computer Link [ch2] (Re fer to Data Communication Ed ition for details.) D 8420 RS2 (FNC 87) [ch2] Communicat ion format [...]
-
Page 861
859 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 862
860 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) FX 3U -CF-ADP [ch1] (Refer to CF-A DP Manual for details .) [D]8400 to [D]840 1 Not used – – – – – – ––– –– [D]8402 Step nu[...]
-
Page 863
861 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 864
862 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) FX 3U -ENET-A DP [ch2] (R efer to ENE T-ADP Manua l for deta ils.) [D]8420 IP A ddress (Lo w-order) – *1 *1 *2 *2 – –––[...]
-
Page 865
863 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.1 Special Devic e List (M8000 -, D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX [...]
-
Page 866
864 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Special De vices (M8000 - and D8000 -) This section expl ains how to use th e provided spe cial devices to acti v[...]
-
Page 867
865 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 868
866 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 37.2.4 Power failure detection time [D8008, M8008 a nd M8007] 1. FX 3U PLC (AC power supply type) The table below shows the allowabl[...]
-
Page 869
867 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 870
868 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 37.2.8 How to set real time clock The real time clock is se t by the following method. 1. Method using the displa y module This subs[...]
-
Page 871
869 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 872
870 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 37.2.9 Input filter adjustment [D8 020] The inputs X000 to X017 *1 have a digi tal filter circuit with a setting ra nge of 0 to 6 0 [...]
-
Page 873
871 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 874
872 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 37.2.11 Built-in analog volume [D8030 a nd D8031] Values of v ariable analo g potentio meters built in FX 3S /FX 3G PLCs *1 as stand[...]
-
Page 875
873 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 876
874 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 4. RUN/STOP command via the programming tool 1) Using the programming softw are for personal comp uter There is a remote RUN/STOP fu[...]
-
Page 877
875 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 878
876 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 2. Special data register (D8260 t o D8279) •F X 3S /FX 3G PLCs *1. In the case of FX 3S PLC, a ll versions are applica ble. *2. On[...]
-
Page 879
877 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 880
878 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) *1. In the case of FX 3U PLCs, all versi ons are ap plicable. Number Operat ion and funct ion FX 3U -4AD-PT(W)- ADP FX 3U -4AD-TC-AD[...]
-
Page 881
879 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 882
880 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 2. Special data registers (D8 260 to D8299) •F X 3U /FX 3UC PLC *1. In the case of FX 3U PLCs, all versi ons are ap plicable. Numb[...]
-
Page 883
881 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 884
882 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) •F X 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC PLC s *1. In the case of FX 3S /FX 3G PLCs, all ve rsions are app licable. *2. Can be connected only to F X[...]
-
Page 885
883 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 37 Operation of Special D evices (M8000 -, D8000 -) 37.2 Supplement of Speci al Devices (M8000 - and D8000 -) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC3[...]
-
Page 886
884 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.1 States and Colors of LEDs PLC Operation Stat us 38. Error Check Method and Error Code List When an error o ccurs while th e program is be ing executed , troublesh oot the cause o f the error in a[...]
-
Page 887
885 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.1 States and Colors of LEDs PLC Operation Stat us 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 888
886 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.1 States and Colors of LEDs PLC Operation Stat us 38.1.5 ERROR (ERR) LED [lit, flickering or unlit] 38.1.6 L RUN LED [FX 3UC -32MT-LT(-2)] *1. FX 3UC -32MT-LT onl y. LED status PLC status Action Li[...]
-
Page 889
887 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.1 States and Colors of LEDs PLC Operation Stat us 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U[...]
-
Page 890
888 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.2 Error Code Check Method and Indication 38.2 Error Code Check Method and Indication 38.2.1 Error code check method by displa y module The error code can be che cked by programming to ol and displa[...]
-
Page 891
889 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.2 Error Code Check Method and Indication 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP [...]
-
Page 892
890 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.2 Error Code Check Method and Indication 38.2.3 Error indication The table below sh ows the error expression i n this manual, GX Work s2, GX Developer, an d display modules (FX 3U - 7DM). • Compa[...]
-
Page 893
891 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.3 Supplementary Expl anation of Devi ces for Error Detecti on 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-[...]
-
Page 894
892 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.3 Supplementary Expl anation of Devi ces for Error Detecti on 38.3.2 Operations of special devices fo r error detection Special auxiliar y relays for error detection and spe cial data registers for[...]
-
Page 895
893 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL[...]
-
Page 896
894 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action PLC hardware er ror [M8061( D8061)] 6103 Stops operation I/O bus error ( M8069 = ON) Verify that exte nsion cabl es are corr ectly co nnected. 6104 Powe red extensi on [...]
-
Page 897
895 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL[...]
-
Page 898
896 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action Syntax err or [M8065( D8065)] 0000 ⎯ No error 6501 Stops operation Incorrect co mbinatio n of instruc tion, devic e symbol and device number During prog ramming, each[...]
-
Page 899
897 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL[...]
-
Page 900
898 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action Operation er ror [M8067(D8 067)] 6748 Continue s operation PID output upp er limit set va lue < PID outpu t lower limi t set value. <Transpose of output upper lim[...]
-
Page 901
899 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL[...]
-
Page 902
900 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 38 Error Check Method and Error Code List 38.4 Error Code List and Action *1. " " indica tes the foll owing values for each sp ecial adap ter/special block wher e an error has occurred. If an error has occurred in 2 or more s[...]
-
Page 903
901 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 904
902 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 2) GX Developer • GX Develo per English ve rsion (SW D5C-GPPW-E) is applicable to FX 3G /FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs from the following versions. ?[...]
-
Page 905
903 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 906
904 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility In FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs 1) RS-422/RS -232C/USB c ommunication The FX 3U /FX 3UC PLCs can write and read p rograms and perform monitorin g at 115.2[...]
-
Page 907
905 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 908
906 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility Cautions on writing during RUN *1. Circuit blocks cannot be e dited to inse rt a label a s shown below when written during RUN. Item Caution Pro[...]
-
Page 909
907 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 910
908 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility Appendix A-1-3 Precautions on Use of (Built-in USB) Programming Port Make sure to set the contents described in this section wh en using the (bu[...]
-
Page 911
909 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX[...]
-
Page 912
910 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-1 Programming Tool Applicab ility Appendix A-1-5 Cautions on usin g transparent (2-port) function of GOT-F900 Series Make sure to provide the following se tting when exe cut ing [...]
-
Page 913
911 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-2 Peripheral pro duct applicabili ty (except programmin g tools) 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Regis[...]
-
Page 914
912 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-2 Peripheral pro duct applicabili ty (except programmin g tools) FX 3G /FX 3GC PLCs FX 3U /FX 3UC PLC *1. The F940GOT a nd ET-940 whose version is earlier th an Ver. 1.10 d o not[...]
-
Page 915
913 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-3 Version Upgrade Hist ory 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF[...]
-
Page 916
914 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-3 Version Upgrade Hist ory Appendix A-3-2 Version check The PLC versio n can be verifie d by monitoring the speci al data register D8001 or D8101 and checki ng the last three dig[...]
-
Page 917
915 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-3 Version Upgrade Hist ory 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF[...]
-
Page 918
916 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition A Programming Tool Applicability and Version Up grade History A-3 Version Upgrade Hist ory *1. The FX 3UC -32MT-LT supports Ve r. 2.41 from the manufacturer's serial number "7X ****" (October 2007). *2. Available in Ver. 2.70 o[...]
-
Page 919
917 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Progr[...]
-
Page 920
918 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time Output in structions OUT Y,M 0.21 1 .2 µ s in 2-step instru ction OUT S 1.25 1.25 OUT T K 2.41 2.16 OUT T D 2.77 2.54 OUT C K 1.9 2.25 1.57 1.72 C235 to C255 1.6 µ s in exe[...]
-
Page 921
919 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Progr[...]
-
Page 922
920 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time *1. M1536 to M3583, M82 56 to M8511, S1024 to S4095 *2. M1536 to M3583, M8000 to M851 1 *3. M3584 to M7679 Output instru ctions OUT T D 2 .77 2.54 T246 to T319 3.06 µ s in e[...]
-
Page 923
921 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Progr[...]
-
Page 924
922 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time *1. M1536 to M3583, M82 56 to M8511, S1024 to S4095 *2. M1536 to M3583, M8000 to M851 1 *3. M3584 to M7679 Output instru ctions OUT T D 3 .55 3.32 T246 to T319 3.83 µ s in e[...]
-
Page 925
923 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Progr[...]
-
Page 926
924 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-1 Basic Inst ruction Execution Time *1. M1536 to M3583, M82 56 to M8511, S1024 to S4095 *2. M1536 to M3583, M8000 to M851 1 *3. M3584 to M7679 Output instru ctions RST S 4.6 0. 13 RST T 0.45 0.45 RST C 0.45 5.8[...]
-
Page 927
925 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-2 Step Ladder Inst ruction Execution Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL[...]
-
Page 928
926 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Appendix B-4 Applied Instruction Execution Time •F X 3S PLC FNC No. Instructi on Execution time in ON status ( µ s) Execution time in OFF status ( µ s) Remarks 16-bit i[...]
-
Page 929
927 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 930
928 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time External de vice 170 GRY 11.46 11 .81 0.61 0.61 171 GBIN 11.46 11.83 0.61 0.61 Data comparison 224 LD= 1.56 1.8 1.5 2 1.76 For details, refe r to Appendix B-6-2. 225 LD>[...]
-
Page 931
929 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 932
930 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Data operation 40 ZRST(D) 7.96+0.22n ⎯ 0.61 ⎯ 10.26+0.22n ⎯ 0.8 ⎯ n: Number of reset points ZRST(T) 8.77+0.46n ⎯ 0.61 ⎯ 10.68+0.46n ⎯ 0.8 ⎯ n: Number of res[...]
-
Page 933
931 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 934
932 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Data comparison 233 AND> 1.88 2.24 1.84 2.28 2.6 3.2 2.6 3.2 For details, refer to Appendix B-6-2 . 234 AND< 1.9 2 2.36 1.84 2.18 2.68 3.28 2.56 3.16 For details, ref[...]
-
Page 935
933 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 936
934 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Data operat ion 40 ZRST(D) 11.1 + 0.19n ⎯ 0.32 5 ⎯ n: Number of res et points ZRST(T) 17. 1 + 0.23n ⎯ 0.325 ⎯ n: Number of reset points ZRST(M) 20.7 + 0.02n ⎯ 0.3[...]
-
Page 937
935 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 938
936 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Floating point 124 EXP ⎯ 11.9 ⎯ 0. 585 125 LOGE ⎯ 24.0 ⎯ 0.58 5 126 LOG10 ⎯ 24.3 ⎯ 0. 585 127 ESQR ⎯ 10.6 ⎯ 0.58 5 128 ENEG ⎯ 8.9 ⎯ 0.325 129 INT 13.2 1[...]
-
Page 939
937 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 940
938 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Character s tring contr ol 206 MIDR 2 5 + 0.59n + 0.68m ⎯ 0.455 ⎯ n: Character position m: Number of characters 207 MIDW 2 5.8 + 0.3m + 0.44n ⎯ 0.455 ⎯ n: Character[...]
-
Page 941
939 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 FX 3U -CF-ADP 35 SFC•STL Pro[...]
-
Page 942
940 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-4 Applied Instruction Execu tion Time Data move 3 277 ⎯ ⎯⎯⎯⎯ 278 RBFM *1 50+900n ⎯ 0.715 ⎯ n : Number of points tran sferred in one operation cycle RBFM *2 244 + 103n ⎯ 0.715 ⎯ 279 WBFM *1 24 [...]
-
Page 943
941 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-5 Execution Time of Pulse Gener ation Instr uction P in Each Applied Inst ruction 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 [...]
-
Page 944
942 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-5 Execution Time of Pulse Gener ation Instr uction P in Each Applied Inst ruction •F X 3G /FX 3GC PLCs (Standard mode) Applied instruction Execution time Remarks MOV instru ction (FNC 12) Execution ti me at r[...]
-
Page 945
943 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-5 Execution Time of Pulse Gener ation Instr uction P in Each Applied Inst ruction 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 [...]
-
Page 946
944 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-6 Execution Time on Combinatio n of Applicable Devices and Indexing Appendix B-6 Execution Time on Combination of A pplicable Devices and Indexing In examples shown below for basic instructions, the MOV instruc[...]
-
Page 947
945 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-6 Execution Time on Combinatio n of Applicable Devices and Indexing 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 [...]
-
Page 948
946 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-6 Execution Time on Combinatio n of Applicable Devices and Indexing - DMOV instruction (32-bit instruction) *1. *2. These combi nations are handled a s excepti ons becaus e high-spe ed processi ng is adop ted i[...]
-
Page 949
947 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition B Instruction Execut ion Time B-6 Execution Time on Combinatio n of Applicable Devices and Indexing 31 FNC277-FNC2 79 Data T ransfer 3 32 FNC280-FNC289 High-Speed Processing 2 33 FNC290-FNC299 Extension File Register Control 34 FNC300-FNC305 [...]
-
Page 950
948 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-1 Applied i nstructions [by instructi on type] Appendix C: Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Order] Appendix C-1 Applied instructi ons [by instr[...]
-
Page 951
949 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-1 Applied i nstructions [by instructi on type] C Applicable Instruction List D Discontinued models OR<> FNC244 OR Comp are ≠ 658 OR <= FNC245 OR Compar e ≤ 6[...]
-
Page 952
950 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-1 Applied i nstructions [by instructi on type] CCD F NC 84 Check Code 466 CRC F NC188 Cyc lic Redundanc y Check 592 LIMIT F NC256 Limi t Control 661 BAND FNC257 Dead Band[...]
-
Page 953
951 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-1 Applied i nstructions [by instructi on type] C Applicable Instruction List D Discontinued models 16. Special unit/block control instruct ions Mnemonic FNC No. Function [...]
-
Page 954
952 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-2 Applied inst ructions [in alphabetic al order] Appendix C-2 Applied instructi ons [in alphabetical order] Mnemonic FNC No. Function Ref. Page Symbol $+ FNC202 Link Char[...]
-
Page 955
953 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-2 Applied inst ructions [in alphabetic al order] C Applicable Instruction List D Discontinued models F FDEL FNC210 Deleting Data from Tables 641 FEND FNC 06 Main Routine [...]
-
Page 956
954 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition C Applied Instruction List [by Instruction Type/in Alphabetic Or der] C-2 Applied inst ructions [in alphabetic al order] P PID FNC 88 PID Control Loop 476 PLSR F NC 59 Acceleration /Decelerat ion Setup 383 PLSV FNC157 Var iable S peed Pulse O[...]
-
Page 957
955 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition D Discontinued mode ls C Applicable Instruction List D Discontinued models Appendix D: Discontinued models The table below sh ows discontinu ed models of MELS EC-F Series PLC s and programming too ls described in thi s manual. Discontinued mo[...]
-
Page 958
956 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition D Discontinued mode ls MEMO[...]
-
Page 959
957 Warranty FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Warranty Please confirm the following product warranty details before using this product. 1. Gratis Warranty Term and Gratis Warranty Range [Gratis Warranty Term] If any faults or defects (hereinafter "Failure") found to be[...]
-
Page 960
958 Revised History FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition Revised History Date Created Revision Desc ription 7/2005 A Firs t Edition 2/2006 B FX 3U and F X 3UC series version 2.30 compatible • Two instructions are added. - MEP, MEF [Section 3.1, Cha pter 7, Appendix A-1-2, Appendix[...]
-
Page 961
959 Revised History FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 3/2007 C • Caution on storin g sign data of charac ter string is added [S ection 26.2]. • The sentence describing rough guide to th e watchdog timer se t value is mod ified [Sections 33 .3 and 33.6]. • Note on using stat[...]
-
Page 962
960 Revised History FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC Series Programming Manual - Basic & Applied Instruction Edition 7/2011 J • S upported in FX 3G series version 1.40 - 1 in struction adde d. IVMC(FNC275 )[Section 30.6 ] • Supported in FX 3U and FX 3UC series version 3.00 - Suppo rts storage of symbolic information . - Suppo rt of the s[...]
-
Page 963
[...]
-
Page 964
HEAD OFFICE: TOKYO BUILDING, 2-7-3 MARUNOUCHI, CHIYODA-KU, TOKYO 100-8310, JAPAN HIMEJI WORKS: 840, CHIYODA CHO, HIMEJI, JAPAN JY997D16601N (MEE) Effective Sep. 2013 Specifications are subject to change withou t notice. MODEL FX-P3-E MODEL CODE 09R517 FX 3S /FX 3G /FX 3GC /FX 3U /FX 3UC SERIES PROGR AMMABLE CO NTROLLERS PROGRAMMING MANUAL Basic &am[...]